[ gas/ChangeLog ]
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
9fe8321b 31@c This is updated by GNU Press.
e9c75b65 32@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c 33
87885426
FN
34@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 36
6c0e9fb3 37@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 38
c906108c 39@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 40@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
41@dircategory Programming & development tools.
42@direntry
c906108c 43* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
44@end direntry
45
c906108c
SS
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
9fe8321b
AC
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52Version @value{GDBVN}.
c906108c 53
8a037dd7 54Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 56
e9c75b65
EZ
57Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
59any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
60Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
61Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 63
6826cf00
EZ
64(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
65freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
66published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
67development.''
c906108c
SS
68@end ifinfo
69
70@titlepage
71@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 73@sp 1
c906108c 74@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
9e9c5ae7 75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 76@page
c906108c
SS
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
53a5351d 84
c906108c 85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 88@sp 2
c906108c
SS
89Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9059 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 92ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
93
94Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
97Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 100
6826cf00
EZ
101(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104development.''
c906108c
SS
105@end titlepage
106@page
107
6c0e9fb3 108@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
109@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
c906108c
SS
111@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
9fe8321b 115This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
116@value{GDBVN}.
117
1e698235 118Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
119
120@menu
121* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128* Stack:: Examining the stack
129* Source:: Examining source files
130* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 131* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 132* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 133* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
134
135* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138* Altering:: Altering execution
139* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 141* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
142* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 145* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
21c294e6 146* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
6d2ebf8b
SS
147* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
148* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 149* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
150
151* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
152* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
153
154* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 157* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 158* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
159* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
160 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 161* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
162* Index:: Index
163@end menu
164
6c0e9fb3 165@end ifnottex
c906108c 166
449f3b6c 167@contents
449f3b6c 168
6d2ebf8b 169@node Summary
c906108c
SS
170@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
171
172The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
173going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
174program was doing at the moment it crashed.
175
176@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
177these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
178
179@itemize @bullet
180@item
181Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
182
183@item
184Make your program stop on specified conditions.
185
186@item
187Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
188
189@item
190Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
191effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
192@end itemize
193
cce74817 194You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 195For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
196For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
197
cce74817 198@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
199Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
200@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 201
cce74817
JM
202@cindex Pascal
203Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
204nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
205entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
206syntax.
c906108c 207
c906108c
SS
208@cindex Fortran
209@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 210it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 211underscore.
c906108c 212
c906108c
SS
213@menu
214* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
215* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
216@end menu
217
6d2ebf8b 218@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
219@unnumberedsec Free software
220
5d161b24 221@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
222General Public License
223(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
224program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
225freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
226the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
227Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
228Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
229
230Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
231you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
232from anyone else.
233
2666264b 234@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
235
236The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
237the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
238include with the free software. Many of our most important
239programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
240texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
241when an important free software package does not come with a free
242manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
243gaps today.
244
245Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
246normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
247authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
248copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
249them from the free software world.
250
251That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
252from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
253manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
254only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
255contract to make it non-free.
256
257Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
258price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
259charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
260Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
261problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
262are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
263modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
264
265The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
266free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
267commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
268accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
269
270Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
271When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
272are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
273provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
274manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
275a changed version of the program is not really available to our
276community.
277
278Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
279acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
280author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
281authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
282to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
283may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
284with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
285are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
286of the manual.
287
288However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
289content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
290media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
291obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
292manual to replace it.
293
294Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
295lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
296free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
297the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
298realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
299the free software community.
300
301If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
302the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
303license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
304don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
305will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
306option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
307what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
308try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 309is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
310
311You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
312manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
313copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
314improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
315at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
316and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
317Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
318have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
319
320The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
321published by other publishers, at
322@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
323
6d2ebf8b 324@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
325@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
326
327Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
328other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
329development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
330of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
331to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
332file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
333blow-by-blow account.
334
335Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
336
337@quotation
338@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
339or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
340omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
341@end quotation
342
343So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
344particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
345releases:
299ffc64 346Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
347Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
348Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
349Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
350Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
351Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
352John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
353Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
354and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
355
356Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
357Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
358
b37052ae
EZ
359Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
360in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
361Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
362demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
363much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 364
b37052ae 365@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
366object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
367Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
368
369David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
370the original support for encapsulated COFF.
371
0179ffac 372Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
c906108c
SS
373
374Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
375Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
376support.
377Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
378Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
379Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
380David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
381Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
382Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
383Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
384Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
385Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
386Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
387Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
388Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
389Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
390Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
391Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 392Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 393
1104b9e7 394Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
395
396Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
397libraries.
398
399Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
400about several machine instruction sets.
401
402Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
403remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
404contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
405and RDI targets, respectively.
406
407Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
408command-line editing and command history.
409
7a292a7a
SS
410Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
411Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 412
5d161b24 413Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 414He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 415symbols.
c906108c
SS
416
417Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
418Super-H processors.
419
420NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
421
422Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
423
424Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
425
426Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
427
96a2c332 428Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
429
430Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
431watchpoints.
432
433Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
434
435Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
436
437Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 438nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
439
440The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
441support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 442(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
443compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
444John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
445Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
446information in this manual.
447
b37052ae
EZ
448DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
449Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
450
96a2c332
SS
451Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
452development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
453fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
454Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
455Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
456Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
457Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
458addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
459JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
460Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
461Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
462Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
463Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
464Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
465Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 466
e2e0bcd1
JB
467Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
468Hat.
c906108c 469
6d2ebf8b 470@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
471@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
472
473You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
474However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
475debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
476
477@iftex
478In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
479to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
480@end iftex
481
482@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
483@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
484
485One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
486processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
487quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
488definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
489session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
490then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
491same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
492@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
493procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
494
495@smallexample
496$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
497$ @b{./m4}
498@b{define(foo,0000)}
499
500@b{foo}
5010000
502@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
503
504@b{bar}
5050000
506@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
507
508@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
509@b{baz}
510@b{C-d}
511m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
516
c906108c
SS
517@smallexample
518$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
519@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
520@c FIXME... format to come out better.
521@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 522 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 523 the conditions.
5d161b24 524There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
525 for details.
526
527@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
528(@value{GDBP})
529@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
530
531@noindent
532@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
533rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
534We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
535that examples fit in this manual.
536
537@smallexample
538(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
539@end smallexample
540
541@noindent
542We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
543Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
544@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
545@code{break} command.
546
547@smallexample
548(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
549Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
550@end smallexample
551
552@noindent
553Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
554control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
555subroutine, the program runs as usual:
556
557@smallexample
558(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
559Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
560@b{define(foo,0000)}
561
562@b{foo}
5630000
564@end smallexample
565
566@noindent
567To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
568suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
569context where it stops.
570
571@smallexample
572@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
573
5d161b24 574Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
575 at builtin.c:879
576879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
577@end smallexample
578
579@noindent
580Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
581the next line of the current function.
582
583@smallexample
584(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
585882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
586 : nil,
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
591by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
592@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
593subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
597set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
598 at input.c:530
599530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
604suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
605shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
606command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
607in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
608stack frame for each active subroutine.
609
610@smallexample
611(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
612#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
613 at input.c:530
5d161b24 614#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
615 at builtin.c:882
616#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
617#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
618 at macro.c:71
619#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
620#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
625times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
626falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
627
628@smallexample
629(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6300x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6320x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
633def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
635536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
636 : xstrdup(rq);
637(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
639@end smallexample
640
641@noindent
642The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
643@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
644and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
645(@code{print}) to see their values.
646
647@smallexample
648(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
649$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
650(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
651$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
652@end smallexample
653
654@noindent
655@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
656To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
657surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
661533 xfree(rquote);
662534
663535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
664 : xstrdup (lq);
665536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
666 : xstrdup (rq);
667537
668538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
669539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
670540 @}
671541
672542 void
673@end smallexample
674
675@noindent
676Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
677@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
678
679@smallexample
680(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683540 @}
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
685$3 = 9
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
687$4 = 7
688@end smallexample
689
690@noindent
691That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
692@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
693@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
694the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
695any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
696assignments.
697
698@smallexample
699(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
700$5 = 7
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
702$6 = 9
703@end smallexample
704
705@noindent
706Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
707@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
708executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
709example that caused trouble initially:
710
711@smallexample
712(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
713Continuing.
714
715@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
716
717baz
7180000
719@end smallexample
720
721@noindent
722Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
723problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
724lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
725
726@smallexample
727@b{C-d}
728Program exited normally.
729@end smallexample
730
731@noindent
732The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
733indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
734session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
735
736@smallexample
737(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
738@end smallexample
c906108c 739
6d2ebf8b 740@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
741@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
742
743This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 744The essentials are:
c906108c 745@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 746@item
53a5351d 747type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 748@item
c906108c
SS
749type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
750@end itemize
751
752@menu
753* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
754* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
755* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
756@end menu
757
6d2ebf8b 758@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
759@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
760
c906108c
SS
761Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
762@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
763
764You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
765to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
766
c906108c
SS
767The command-line options described here are designed
768to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 769options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
770
771The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
772specifying an executable program:
773
474c8240 774@smallexample
c906108c 775@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 776@end smallexample
c906108c 777
c906108c
SS
778@noindent
779You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
780specified:
781
474c8240 782@smallexample
c906108c 783@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 784@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
785
786You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
787to debug a running process:
788
474c8240 789@smallexample
c906108c 790@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 791@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
792
793@noindent
794would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
795named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
796
c906108c 797Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
798complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
799debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
800``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
801will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 802
aa26fa3a
TT
803You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
804executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
805option processing.
474c8240 806@smallexample
aa26fa3a 807gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 808@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
809This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
810@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
811
96a2c332 812You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
813@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
814
815@smallexample
816@value{GDBP} -silent
817@end smallexample
818
819@noindent
820You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
821options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
822
823@noindent
824Type
825
474c8240 826@smallexample
c906108c 827@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 828@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
829
830@noindent
831to display all available options and briefly describe their use
832(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
833
834All options and command line arguments you give are processed
835in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
836@samp{-x} option is used.
837
838
839@menu
c906108c
SS
840* File Options:: Choosing files
841* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
842@end menu
843
6d2ebf8b 844@node File Options
c906108c
SS
845@subsection Choosing files
846
2df3850c 847When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
848specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
849the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
850@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
851first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
852equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
853second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
854equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
855If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
856first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
857to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
858a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 859prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
860
861If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
862such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
863argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
864
865Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
866following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
867them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
868(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
869than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
870
d700128c
EZ
871@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
872@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
873@c it.
874
c906108c
SS
875@table @code
876@item -symbols @var{file}
877@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
878@cindex @code{--symbols}
879@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
880Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
881
882@item -exec @var{file}
883@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
884@cindex @code{--exec}
885@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
886Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
887and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
888
889@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 890@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
891Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
892file.
893
c906108c
SS
894@item -core @var{file}
895@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
896@cindex @code{--core}
897@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 898Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
899
900@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
901@item -pid @var{number}
902@itemx -p @var{number}
903@cindex @code{--pid}
904@cindex @code{-p}
905Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
906If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
907file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
908
909@item -command @var{file}
910@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--command}
912@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
913Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
914Files,, Command files}.
915
916@item -directory @var{directory}
917@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
918@cindex @code{--directory}
919@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
920Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
921
c906108c
SS
922@item -m
923@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
924@cindex @code{--mapped}
925@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
926@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
927supported on all systems.}@*
928If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 929system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
930to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
931program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 932called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
933Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
934and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
935the symbol table from the executable program.
936
937The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
938is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
939table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 940
c906108c
SS
941@item -r
942@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
943@cindex @code{--readnow}
944@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
945Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
946the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
947This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 948
c906108c
SS
949@end table
950
2df3850c 951You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 952order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
953information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
954on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
955but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 956
474c8240 957@smallexample
2df3850c 958gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 959@end smallexample
c906108c 960
6d2ebf8b 961@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
962@subsection Choosing modes
963
964You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
965batch mode or quiet mode.
966
967@table @code
968@item -nx
969@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
970@cindex @code{--nx}
971@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 972Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
973@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
974options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
975files}.
c906108c
SS
976
977@item -quiet
d700128c 978@itemx -silent
c906108c 979@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
980@cindex @code{--quiet}
981@cindex @code{--silent}
982@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
983``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
984messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
985
986@item -batch
d700128c 987@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
988Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
989command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
990initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
991nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
992in the command files.
993
2df3850c
JM
994Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
995example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
996make this more useful, the message
c906108c 997
474c8240 998@smallexample
c906108c 999Program exited normally.
474c8240 1000@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1001
1002@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1003(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1004@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1005mode.
1006
1007@item -nowindows
1008@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1009@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1010@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1011``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1012(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1013interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1014
1015@item -windows
1016@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1017@cindex @code{--windows}
1018@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1019If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1020used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1021
1022@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1023@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1024Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1025instead of the current directory.
1026
c906108c
SS
1027@item -fullname
1028@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1029@cindex @code{--fullname}
1030@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1031@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1032subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1033number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1034displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1035recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1036the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1037and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1038@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1039frame.
c906108c 1040
d700128c
EZ
1041@item -epoch
1042@cindex @code{--epoch}
1043The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1044@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1045routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1046separate window.
1047
1048@item -annotate @var{level}
1049@cindex @code{--annotate}
1050This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1051effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1052(@pxref{Annotations}).
1053Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1054together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1055types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1056@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1057maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1058
1059@item -async
1060@cindex @code{--async}
1061Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1062@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1063special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1064commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1065run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1066MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1067suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1068control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1069(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1070operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1071yet.)
1072@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1073@c should be removed.
1074
1075When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1076uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1077@samp{-noasync} option.
1078
1079@item -noasync
1080@cindex @code{--noasync}
1081Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1082
aa26fa3a
TT
1083@item --args
1084@cindex @code{--args}
1085Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1086executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1087This option stops option processing.
1088
2df3850c
JM
1089@item -baud @var{bps}
1090@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1091@cindex @code{--baud}
1092@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1093Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1094interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1095
1096@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1097@itemx -t @var{device}
1098@cindex @code{--tty}
1099@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1100Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1101@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1102
53a5351d 1103@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1104@item -tui
1105@cindex @code{--tui}
1106Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1107The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1108showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1109(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1110Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1111(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1112
1113@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1114@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1115@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1116@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1117@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1118@c systems.
1119
d700128c
EZ
1120@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1121@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1122Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1123program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0 1124communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
21c294e6 1125@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
94bbb2c0 1126
da0f9dcd
AC
1127@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1128@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1129(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1130interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1131@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1132are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1133
1134@item -write
1135@cindex @code{--write}
1136Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1137is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1138(@pxref{Patching}).
1139
1140@item -statistics
1141@cindex @code{--statistics}
1142This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1143memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1144
1145@item -version
1146@cindex @code{--version}
1147This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1148no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1149
c906108c
SS
1150@end table
1151
6d2ebf8b 1152@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1153@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1154@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1156
1157@table @code
1158@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1159@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1160@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1161@itemx q
1162To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1163@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1164do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1165otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1166error code.
c906108c
SS
1167@end table
1168
1169@cindex interrupt
1170An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1171terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1172returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1173character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1174until a time when it is safe.
1175
c906108c
SS
1176If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1177device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1178(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1179
6d2ebf8b 1180@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1181@section Shell commands
1182
1183If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1184debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1185just use the @code{shell} command.
1186
1187@table @code
1188@kindex shell
1189@cindex shell escape
1190@item shell @var{command string}
1191Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1192If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1193shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1194(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1195@end table
1196
1197The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1198You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1199@value{GDBN}:
1200
1201@table @code
1202@kindex make
1203@cindex calling make
1204@item make @var{make-args}
1205Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1206arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1207@end table
1208
6d2ebf8b 1209@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1210@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1211
1212You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1213name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1214@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1215key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1216show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1217
1218@menu
1219* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1220* Completion:: Command completion
1221* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1222@end menu
1223
6d2ebf8b 1224@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1225@section Command syntax
1226
1227A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1228how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1229arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1230command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1231step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1232with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1233
1234@cindex abbreviation
1235@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1236unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1237documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1238abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1239equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1240names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1241arguments to the @code{help} command.
1242
1243@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1244@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1245A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1246repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1247will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1248repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1249repeat.
1250
1251The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1252@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1253exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1254
1255@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1256output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1257(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1258@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1259repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1260
41afff9a 1261@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1262@cindex comment
1263Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1264nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1265Files,,Command files}).
1266
88118b3a
TT
1267@cindex repeating command sequences
1268@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1269The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1270commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1271then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1272for editing.
1273
6d2ebf8b 1274@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1275@section Command completion
1276
1277@cindex completion
1278@cindex word completion
1279@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1280only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1281are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1282commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1283
1284Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1285of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1286word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1287enter it). For example, if you type
1288
1289@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1290@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1291@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1292@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1293@smallexample
c906108c 1294(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1295@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1296
1297@noindent
1298@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1299the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1300
474c8240 1301@smallexample
c906108c 1302(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1303@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1304
1305@noindent
1306You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1307breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1308@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1309were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1310might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1311to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1312
1313If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1314@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1315characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1316@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1317example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1318begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1319just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1320function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1321example:
1322
474c8240 1323@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1324(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1325@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1326make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1327make_abs_section make_function_type
1328make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1329make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1330make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1331(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1332@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1333
1334@noindent
1335After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1336partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1337command.
1338
1339If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1340can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1341means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1342key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1343one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1344
1345@cindex quotes in commands
1346@cindex completion of quoted strings
1347Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1348parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1349its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1350situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1351@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1352
c906108c 1353The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1354name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1355overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1356by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1357may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1358that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1359that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1360word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1361@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1362@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1363when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1364
474c8240 1365@smallexample
96a2c332 1366(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1367bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1368(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1369@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1370
1371In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1372quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1373completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1374place:
1375
474c8240 1376@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1377(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1378@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1379(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1380@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1381
1382@noindent
1383In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1384you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1385completion on an overloaded symbol.
1386
d4f3574e 1387For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1388expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1389overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1390see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1391
1392
6d2ebf8b 1393@node Help
c906108c
SS
1394@section Getting help
1395@cindex online documentation
1396@kindex help
1397
5d161b24 1398You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1399using the command @code{help}.
1400
1401@table @code
41afff9a 1402@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1403@item help
1404@itemx h
1405You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1406display a short list of named classes of commands:
1407
1408@smallexample
1409(@value{GDBP}) help
1410List of classes of commands:
1411
2df3850c 1412aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1413breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1414data -- Examining data
c906108c 1415files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1416internals -- Maintenance commands
1417obscure -- Obscure features
1418running -- Running the program
1419stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1420status -- Status inquiries
1421support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1422tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1423 stopping the program
c906108c 1424user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1425
5d161b24 1426Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1427commands in that class.
5d161b24 1428Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1429documentation.
1430Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1431(@value{GDBP})
1432@end smallexample
96a2c332 1433@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1434
1435@item help @var{class}
1436Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1437list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1438help display for the class @code{status}:
1439
1440@smallexample
1441(@value{GDBP}) help status
1442Status inquiries.
1443
1444List of commands:
1445
1446@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1447@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1448info -- Generic command for showing things
1449 about the program being debugged
1450show -- Generic command for showing things
1451 about the debugger
c906108c 1452
5d161b24 1453Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1454documentation.
1455Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1456(@value{GDBP})
1457@end smallexample
1458
1459@item help @var{command}
1460With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1461short paragraph on how to use that command.
1462
6837a0a2
DB
1463@kindex apropos
1464@item apropos @var{args}
1465The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1466commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1467@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1468
1469@smallexample
1470apropos reload
1471@end smallexample
1472
b37052ae
EZ
1473@noindent
1474results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1475
1476@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1477@c @group
1478set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1479 multiple times in one run
1480show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1481 multiple times in one run
1482@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1483@end smallexample
1484
c906108c
SS
1485@kindex complete
1486@item complete @var{args}
1487The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1488for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1489command you want completed. For example:
1490
1491@smallexample
1492complete i
1493@end smallexample
1494
1495@noindent results in:
1496
1497@smallexample
1498@group
2df3850c
JM
1499if
1500ignore
c906108c
SS
1501info
1502inspect
c906108c
SS
1503@end group
1504@end smallexample
1505
1506@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1507@end table
1508
1509In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1510and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1511of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1512manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1513under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1514all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1515
1516@c @group
1517@table @code
1518@kindex info
41afff9a 1519@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1520@item info
1521This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1522program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1523with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1524registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1525You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1526@w{@code{help info}}.
1527
1528@kindex set
1529@item set
5d161b24 1530You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1531@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1532@code{set prompt $}.
1533
1534@kindex show
1535@item show
5d161b24 1536In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1537@value{GDBN} itself.
1538You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1539related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1540system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1541which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1542
1543@kindex info set
1544To display all the settable parameters and their current
1545values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1546@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1547@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1548@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1549@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1550@end table
1551@c @end group
1552
1553Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1554exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1555
1556@table @code
1557@kindex show version
1558@cindex version number
1559@item show version
1560Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1561information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1562@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1563version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1564commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1565system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1566variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1567The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1568@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1569
1570@kindex show copying
1571@item show copying
1572Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1573
1574@kindex show warranty
1575@item show warranty
2df3850c 1576Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1577if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1578
c906108c
SS
1579@end table
1580
6d2ebf8b 1581@node Running
c906108c
SS
1582@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1583
1584When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1585debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1586
1587You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1588of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1589your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1590kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1591
1592@menu
1593* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1594* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1595* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1596* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1597
1598* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1599* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1600* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1601* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1602
1603* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1604* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1605@end menu
1606
6d2ebf8b 1607@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1608@section Compiling for debugging
1609
1610In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1611debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1612is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1613variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1614and addresses in the executable code.
1615
1616To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1617the compiler.
1618
e2e0bcd1
JB
1619Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1620the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1621because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1622the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1623options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1624debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1625``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1626to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1627@option{-g} alone.
1628
c906108c
SS
1629Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1630options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1631executables containing debugging information.
1632
53a5351d
JM
1633@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1634without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1635recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1636program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1637in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1638
1639@cindex optimized code, debugging
1640@cindex debugging optimized code
1641When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1642optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1643really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1644exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1645variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1646variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1647
1648Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1649@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1650doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1651please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1652
1653Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1654@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1655format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1656
1657@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1658@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1659@section Starting your program
1660@cindex starting
1661@cindex running
1662
1663@table @code
1664@kindex run
41afff9a 1665@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1666@item run
1667@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1668Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1669You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1670argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1671@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1672(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1673
1674@end table
1675
c906108c
SS
1676If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1677supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1678that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1679@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1680
1681The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1682receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1683information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1684can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1685your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1686divided into four categories:
1687
1688@table @asis
1689@item The @emph{arguments.}
1690Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1691@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1692is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1693(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1694the arguments.
1695In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1696@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1697@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1698
1699@item The @emph{environment.}
1700Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1701use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1702environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1703your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1704
1705@item The @emph{working directory.}
1706Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1707the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1708@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1709
1710@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1711Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1712standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1713in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1714set a different device for your program.
1715@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1716
1717@cindex pipes
1718@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1719pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1720program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1721wrong program.
1722@end table
c906108c
SS
1723
1724When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1725immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1726of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1727stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1728or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1729
1730If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1731time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1732table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1733your current breakpoints.
1734
6d2ebf8b 1735@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1736@section Your program's arguments
1737
1738@cindex arguments (to your program)
1739The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1740@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1741They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1742performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1743@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1744@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1745the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1746
1747On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1748@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1749calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1750the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1751
1752@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1753@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1754
c906108c 1755@table @code
41afff9a 1756@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1757@item set args
1758Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1759@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1760with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1761using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1762it again without arguments.
1763
1764@kindex show args
1765@item show args
1766Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1767@end table
1768
6d2ebf8b 1769@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1770@section Your program's environment
1771
1772@cindex environment (of your program)
1773The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1774their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1775your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1776path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1777the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1778debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1779environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1780
1781@table @code
1782@kindex path
1783@item path @var{directory}
1784Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1785(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1786The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1787You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1788system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1789MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1790is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1791
1792You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1793working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1794use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1795@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1796@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1797@var{directory} to the search path.
1798@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1799@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1800
1801@kindex show paths
1802@item show paths
1803Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1804environment variable).
1805
1806@kindex show environment
1807@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1808Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1809your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1810print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1811your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1812
1813@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1814@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1815Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1816changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1817be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1818any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1819parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1820null value.
1821@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1822@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1823
1824For example, this command:
1825
474c8240 1826@smallexample
c906108c 1827set env USER = foo
474c8240 1828@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1829
1830@noindent
d4f3574e 1831tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1832@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1833are not actually required.)
1834
1835@kindex unset environment
1836@item unset environment @var{varname}
1837Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1838program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1839@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1840rather than assigning it an empty value.
1841@end table
1842
d4f3574e
SS
1843@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1844the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1845by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1846@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1847that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1848@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1849your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1850files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1851@file{.profile}.
1852
6d2ebf8b 1853@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1854@section Your program's working directory
1855
1856@cindex working directory (of your program)
1857Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1858working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1859The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1860from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1861working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1862
1863The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1864that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1865specify files}.
1866
1867@table @code
1868@kindex cd
1869@item cd @var{directory}
1870Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1871
1872@kindex pwd
1873@item pwd
1874Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1875@end table
1876
6d2ebf8b 1877@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1878@section Your program's input and output
1879
1880@cindex redirection
1881@cindex i/o
1882@cindex terminal
1883By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1884the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1885to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1886modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1887running your program.
1888
1889@table @code
1890@kindex info terminal
1891@item info terminal
1892Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1893program is using.
1894@end table
1895
1896You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1897redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1898
474c8240 1899@smallexample
c906108c 1900run > outfile
474c8240 1901@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1902
1903@noindent
1904starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1905
1906@kindex tty
1907@cindex controlling terminal
1908Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1909with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1910argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1911commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1912process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1913
474c8240 1914@smallexample
c906108c 1915tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1916@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1917
1918@noindent
1919directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1920default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1921that as their controlling terminal.
1922
1923An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1924effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1925terminal.
1926
1927When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1928command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1929for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1930
6d2ebf8b 1931@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1932@section Debugging an already-running process
1933@kindex attach
1934@cindex attach
1935
1936@table @code
1937@item attach @var{process-id}
1938This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1939outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1940targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1941find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1942or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1943
1944@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1945executing the command.
1946@end table
1947
1948To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1949which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1950programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1951also have permission to send the process a signal.
1952
1953When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1954the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1955the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1956(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1957the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1958Specify Files}.
1959
1960The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1961process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1962with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1963you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1964can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1965process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1966attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1967
1968@table @code
1969@kindex detach
1970@item detach
1971When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1972@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1973the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1974that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1975are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1976@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1977executing the command.
1978@end table
1979
1980If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1981attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1982for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1983control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1984confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1985messages}).
1986
6d2ebf8b 1987@node Kill Process
c906108c 1988@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1989
1990@table @code
1991@kindex kill
1992@item kill
1993Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1994@end table
1995
1996This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1997running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1998is running.
1999
2000On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2001while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2002@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2003outside the debugger.
2004
2005The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2006relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2007executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2008next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2009reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2010breakpoint settings).
2011
6d2ebf8b 2012@node Threads
c906108c 2013@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2014
2015@cindex threads of execution
2016@cindex multiple threads
2017@cindex switching threads
2018In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2019may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2020of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2021the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2022that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2023modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2024registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2025
2026@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2027programs:
2028
2029@itemize @bullet
2030@item automatic notification of new threads
2031@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2032@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2033@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2034a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2035@item thread-specific breakpoints
2036@end itemize
2037
c906108c
SS
2038@quotation
2039@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2040@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2041If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2042effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2043from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2044like this:
2045
2046@smallexample
2047(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2048(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2049Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2050see the IDs of currently known threads.
2051@end smallexample
2052@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2053@c doesn't support threads"?
2054@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2055
2056@cindex focus of debugging
2057@cindex current thread
2058The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2059threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2060control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2061This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2062program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2063
41afff9a 2064@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2065@cindex thread identifier (system)
2066@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2067@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2068@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2069Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2070the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2071form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2072whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2073LynxOS, you might see
2074
474c8240 2075@smallexample
c906108c 2076[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2077@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2078
2079@noindent
2080when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2081the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2082further qualifier.
2083
2084@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2085@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2086@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2087@c program?
2088@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2089@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2090@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2091
2092@cindex thread number
2093@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2094For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2095number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2096
2097@table @code
2098@kindex info threads
2099@item info threads
2100Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2101program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2102
2103@enumerate
2104@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2105
2106@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2107
2108@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2109@end enumerate
2110
2111@noindent
2112An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2113indicates the current thread.
2114
5d161b24 2115For example,
c906108c
SS
2116@end table
2117@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2118
2119@smallexample
2120(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2122 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2124 at threadtest.c:68
2125@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2126
2127On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2128
2129@cindex thread number
2130@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2131For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2132number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2133thread in your program.
2134
41afff9a
EZ
2135@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2136@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2137@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2138@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2139@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2140Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2141both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2142form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2143whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2144HP-UX, you see
2145
474c8240 2146@smallexample
c906108c 2147[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2148@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2149
2150@noindent
5d161b24 2151when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2152
2153@table @code
2154@kindex info threads
2155@item info threads
2156Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2157program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2158
2159@enumerate
2160@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2161
2162@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2163
2164@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2165@end enumerate
2166
2167@noindent
2168An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2169indicates the current thread.
2170
5d161b24 2171For example,
c906108c
SS
2172@end table
2173@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2174
474c8240 2175@smallexample
c906108c 2176(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2177 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2178 at quicksort.c:137
2179 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2180 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2181 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2182 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2183@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2184
2185@table @code
2186@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2187@item thread @var{threadno}
2188Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2189argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2190shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2191@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2192you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2193
2194@smallexample
2195@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2196(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2197[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21980x34e5 in sigpause ()
2199@end smallexample
2200
2201@noindent
2202As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2203@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2204threads.
c906108c
SS
2205
2206@kindex thread apply
2207@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2208The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2209more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2210with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2211@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2212threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2213@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2214@end table
2215
2216@cindex automatic thread selection
2217@cindex switching threads automatically
2218@cindex threads, automatic switching
2219Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2220signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2221signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2222message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2223thread.
2224
2225@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2226more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2227programs with multiple threads.
2228
2229@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2230watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2231
6d2ebf8b 2232@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2233@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2234
2235@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2236@cindex multiple processes
2237@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2238On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2239programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2240function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2241parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2242set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2243will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2244will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2245
2246However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2247which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2248the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2249only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2250so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2251on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2252get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2253@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2254the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2255the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2256
53a5351d
JM
2257On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2258debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2259@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2260
2261By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2262the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2263
2264If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2265use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2266
2267@table @code
2268@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2269@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2270Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2271@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2272process. The @var{mode} can be:
2273
2274@table @code
2275@item parent
2276The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2277unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2278
2279@item child
2280The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2281unimpeded.
2282
2283@item ask
2284The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2285@end table
2286
2287@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2288Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2289@end table
2290
2291If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2292@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2293breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2294@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2295the child process's @code{main}.
2296
2297When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2298child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2299
2300If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2301call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2302use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2303argument.
2304
2305You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2306a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2307Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2308
6d2ebf8b 2309@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2310@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2311
2312The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2313program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2314trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2315
7a292a7a
SS
2316Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2317such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2318@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2319change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2320continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2321ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2322explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2323
2324@table @code
2325@kindex info program
2326@item info program
2327Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2328running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2329@end table
2330
2331@menu
2332* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2333* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2334* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2335* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2336@end menu
2337
6d2ebf8b 2338@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2339@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2340
2341@cindex breakpoints
2342A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2343the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2344control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2345breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2346Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2347should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2348program.
2349
2350In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2351breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2352a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2353is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2354not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2355arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2356
2357@cindex watchpoints
2358@cindex memory tracing
2359@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2360@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2361A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2362when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2363command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2364watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2365any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2366and watchpoints using the same commands.
2367
2368You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2369whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2370Automatic display}.
2371
2372@cindex catchpoints
2373@cindex breakpoint on events
2374A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2375when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2376exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2377different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2378catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2379other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2380@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2381
2382@cindex breakpoint numbers
2383@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2384@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2385catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2386starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2387features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2388breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2389@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2390enable it again.
2391
c5394b80
JM
2392@cindex breakpoint ranges
2393@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2394Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2395operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2396@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2397hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2398all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2399
c906108c
SS
2400@menu
2401* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2402* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2403* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2404* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2405* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2406* Conditions:: Break conditions
2407* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2408* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2409* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2410@end menu
2411
6d2ebf8b 2412@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2413@subsection Setting breakpoints
2414
5d161b24 2415@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2416@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2417@c
2418@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2419
2420@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2421@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2422@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2423@cindex latest breakpoint
2424Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2425@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2426number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2427Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2428convenience variables.
2429
2430You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2431
2432@table @code
2433@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2434Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2435When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2436C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2437@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2438
2439@item break +@var{offset}
2440@itemx break -@var{offset}
2441Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2442at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2443(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2444
2445@item break @var{linenum}
2446Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2447The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2448The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2449code on that line.
2450
2451@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2452Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2453
2454@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2455Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2456@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2457superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2458functions.
2459
2460@item break *@var{address}
2461Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2462breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2463information or source files.
2464
2465@item break
2466When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2467the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2468(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2469innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2470returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2471@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2472that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2473@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2474the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2475inside loops.
2476
2477@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2478least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2479would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2480breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2481existed when your program stopped.
2482
2483@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2484Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2485@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2486value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2487@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2488above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2489,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2490
2491@kindex tbreak
2492@item tbreak @var{args}
2493Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2494same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2495way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2496program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2497
c906108c
SS
2498@kindex hbreak
2499@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2500Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2501@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2502breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2503have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2504debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2505changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2506provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2507will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2508address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2509breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2510example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2511@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2512or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2513(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
501eef12
AC
2514@xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2515
c906108c
SS
2516
2517@kindex thbreak
2518@item thbreak @var{args}
2519Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2520are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2521the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2522the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2523first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2524command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2525may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2526See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2527
2528@kindex rbreak
2529@cindex regular expression
2530@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2531Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2532@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2533matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2534breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2535the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2536them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2537
2538The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2539like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2540shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2541an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2542@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2543match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2544
b37052ae 2545When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2546breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2547classes.
c906108c
SS
2548
2549@kindex info breakpoints
2550@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2551@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2554Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2555not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2556
2557@table @emph
2558@item Breakpoint Numbers
2559@item Type
2560Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2561@item Disposition
2562Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2563@item Enabled or Disabled
2564Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2565that are not enabled.
2566@item Address
2df3850c 2567Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2568@item What
2569Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2570line number.
2571@end table
2572
2573@noindent
2574If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2575the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2576are listed after that.
2577
2578@noindent
2579@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2580number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2581convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2582the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2583listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2584
2585@noindent
2586@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2587has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2588@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2589hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2590was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2591will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2592@end table
2593
2594@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2595your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2596the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2597(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2598
2599@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2600@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2601@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2602special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2603programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2604starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2605You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2606@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2607
2608
6d2ebf8b 2609@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2610@subsection Setting watchpoints
2611
2612@cindex setting watchpoints
2613@cindex software watchpoints
2614@cindex hardware watchpoints
2615You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2616expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2617this may happen.
2618
2619Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2620hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2621program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2622times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2623catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2624culprit.)
2625
1104b9e7 2626On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2627@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2628hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2629program.
2630
2631@table @code
2632@kindex watch
2633@item watch @var{expr}
2634Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2635is written into by the program and its value changes.
2636
2637@kindex rwatch
2638@item rwatch @var{expr}
2639Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2640
2641@kindex awatch
2642@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2643Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2644by the program.
c906108c
SS
2645
2646@kindex info watchpoints
2647@item info watchpoints
2648This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2649it is the same as @code{info break}.
2650@end table
2651
2652@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2653watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2654value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2655cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2656executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2657statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2658
2659When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2660
474c8240 2661@smallexample
c906108c 2662Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2663@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2664
2665@noindent
2666if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2667
7be570e7
JM
2668Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2669hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2670value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2671every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2672that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2673hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2674will print a message like this:
2675
2676@smallexample
2677Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2678@end smallexample
2679
2680Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2681data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2682watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2683can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2684cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2685double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2686wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2687into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2688
2689If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2690to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2691Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2692time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2693able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2694warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2695
2696@smallexample
2697Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2698@end smallexample
2699
2700@noindent
2701If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2702
2703The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2704or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2705data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2706hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2707both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2708watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2709@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2710watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2711@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2712Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2713
2714If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2715any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2716kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2717
7be570e7
JM
2718@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2719(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2720they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2721which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2722being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2723and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2724rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2725way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2726@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2727
c906108c
SS
2728@quotation
2729@cindex watchpoints and threads
2730@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2731@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2732usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2733can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2734you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2735thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2736can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2737@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2738the expression.
53a5351d 2739
d4f3574e 2740@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2741@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2742have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2743watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2744single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2745change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2746confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2747software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2748when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2749watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2750@end quotation
c906108c 2751
501eef12
AC
2752@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2753
6d2ebf8b 2754@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2755@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2756@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2757@cindex exception handlers
2758@cindex event handling
2759
2760You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2761kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2762shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2763
2764@table @code
2765@kindex catch
2766@item catch @var{event}
2767Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2768@table @code
2769@item throw
2770@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2771The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2772
2773@item catch
2774@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2775The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2776
2777@item exec
2778@kindex catch exec
2779A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2780
2781@item fork
2782@kindex catch fork
2783A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2784
2785@item vfork
2786@kindex catch vfork
2787A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2788
2789@item load
2790@itemx load @var{libname}
2791@kindex catch load
2792The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2793@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2794
2795@item unload
2796@itemx unload @var{libname}
2797@kindex catch unload
2798The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2799of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2800@end table
2801
2802@item tcatch @var{event}
2803Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2804automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2805
2806@end table
2807
2808Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2809
b37052ae 2810There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2811(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2812
2813@itemize @bullet
2814@item
2815If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2816control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2817raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2818returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2819simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2820that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2821you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2822disabled within interactive calls.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2826
2827@item
2828You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2829@end itemize
2830
2831@cindex raise exceptions
2832Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2833if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2834stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2835can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2836breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2837out where the exception was raised.
2838
2839To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2840knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2841raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2842which has the following ANSI C interface:
2843
474c8240 2844@smallexample
c906108c 2845 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2846 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2847 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2848@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2849
2850@noindent
2851To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2852unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2853(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2854
2855With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2856that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2857a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2858breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2859raised.
2860
2861
6d2ebf8b 2862@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2863@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2864
2865@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2866@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2867It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2868catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2869to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2870breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2871
2872With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2873where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2874delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2875their breakpoint numbers.
2876
2877It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2878automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2879when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2880
2881@table @code
2882@kindex clear
2883@item clear
2884Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2885selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2886the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2887breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2888
2889@item clear @var{function}
2890@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2891Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2892
2893@item clear @var{linenum}
2894@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2895Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2896
2897@cindex delete breakpoints
2898@kindex delete
41afff9a 2899@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2900@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2901Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2902ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2903breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2904confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2905@end table
2906
6d2ebf8b 2907@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2908@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2909
2910@kindex disable breakpoints
2911@kindex enable breakpoints
2912Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2913prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2914it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2915that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2916
2917You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2918the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2919or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2920@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2921catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2922
2923A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2924states of enablement:
2925
2926@itemize @bullet
2927@item
2928Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2929with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2930@item
2931Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2932@item
2933Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2934disabled.
c906108c
SS
2935@item
2936Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2937immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2938set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2939@end itemize
2940
2941You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2942watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2943
2944@table @code
2945@kindex disable breakpoints
2946@kindex disable
41afff9a 2947@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2948@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2949Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2950listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2951options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2952case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2953@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2954
2955@kindex enable breakpoints
2956@kindex enable
c5394b80 2957@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2958Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2959become effective once again in stopping your program.
2960
c5394b80 2961@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2962Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2963of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2964
c5394b80 2965@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2966Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2967deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2968@end table
2969
d4f3574e
SS
2970@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2971@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2972Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2973,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2974subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2975the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2976breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2977breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2978stepping}.)
2979
6d2ebf8b 2980@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2981@subsection Break conditions
2982@cindex conditional breakpoints
2983@cindex breakpoint conditions
2984
2985@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2986@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2987The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2988specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2989breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2990programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2991a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2992and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2993
2994This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2995situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2996when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2997by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2998@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2999
3000Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3001since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3002it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3003and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3004one.
3005
3006Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3007your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3008that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3009format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3010unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3011that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3012program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3013breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3014conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3015purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3016(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3017
3018Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3019@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3020Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3021with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3022
c906108c
SS
3023You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3024The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3025@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3026catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3027
3028@table @code
3029@kindex condition
3030@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3031Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3032watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3033breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3034@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3035@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3036syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3037referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3038symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3039prints an error message:
3040
474c8240 3041@smallexample
d4f3574e 3042No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3043@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3044
3045@noindent
c906108c
SS
3046@value{GDBN} does
3047not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3048command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3049@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3050
3051@item condition @var{bnum}
3052Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3053an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3054@end table
3055
3056@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3057A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3058breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3059useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3060count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3061is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3062therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3063ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3064the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3065value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3066your program reaches it.
3067
3068@table @code
3069@kindex ignore
3070@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3071Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3072The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3073execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3074takes no action.
3075
3076To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3077a count of zero.
3078
3079When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3080breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3081@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3082Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3083
3084If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3085condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3086@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3087
3088You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3089as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3090is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3091variables}.
3092@end table
3093
3094Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3095
3096
6d2ebf8b 3097@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3098@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3099
3100@cindex breakpoint commands
3101You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3102commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3103example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3104enable other breakpoints.
3105
3106@table @code
3107@kindex commands
3108@kindex end
3109@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3110@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3111@itemx end
3112Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3113themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3114@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3115
3116To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3117follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3118
3119With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3120breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3121recently encountered).
3122@end table
3123
3124Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3125disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3126
3127You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3128use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3129that resumes execution.
3130
3131Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3132execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3133(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3134another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3135ambiguities about which list to execute.
3136
3137@kindex silent
3138If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3139usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3140be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3141then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3142see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3143meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3144
3145The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3146print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3147breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3148
3149For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3150value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3151
474c8240 3152@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3153break foo if x>0
3154commands
3155silent
3156printf "x is %d\n",x
3157cont
3158end
474c8240 3159@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3160
3161One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3162you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3163of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3164erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3165to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3166so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3167command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3168
474c8240 3169@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3170break 403
3171commands
3172silent
3173set x = y + 4
3174cont
3175end
474c8240 3176@end smallexample
c906108c 3177
6d2ebf8b 3178@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3179@subsection Breakpoint menus
3180@cindex overloading
3181@cindex symbol overloading
3182
b37052ae 3183Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3184to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3185This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3186@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3187a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3188something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3189particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3190you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3191waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3192options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3193sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3194@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3195breakpoints.
3196
3197For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3198breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3199We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3200
3201@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3202@smallexample
3203@group
3204(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3205[0] cancel
3206[1] all
3207[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3208[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3209[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3210[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3211[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3212[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3213> 2 4 6
3214Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3215Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3216Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3217Multiple breakpoints were set.
3218Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3219 breakpoints.
3220(@value{GDBP})
3221@end group
3222@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3223
3224@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3225@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3226@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3227@c
3228@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3229@c
d4f3574e
SS
3230Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3231any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3232attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3233@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3234
474c8240 3235@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236Cannot insert breakpoints.
3237The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3238@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3239
3240When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3241
3242@enumerate
3243@item
3244Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3245
3246@item
5d161b24 3247Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3248name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3249that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3250Then start your program again.
3251
3252@item
3253Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3254linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3255to nonsharable executables.
3256@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3257@c @end ifclear
3258
d4f3574e
SS
3259A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3260hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3261
3262@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3263@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3264@smallexample
3265Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3266You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3267@end smallexample
3268
3269@noindent
3270This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3271only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3272watchpoints it needs to insert.
3273
3274When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3275hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3276
3277
6d2ebf8b 3278@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3279@section Continuing and stepping
3280
3281@cindex stepping
3282@cindex continuing
3283@cindex resuming execution
3284@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3285completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3286one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3287line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3288particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3289your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3290it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3291@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3292
3293@table @code
3294@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3295@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3296@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3297@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3298@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3299@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3300Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3301any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3302@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3303ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3304@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3305
3306The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3307stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3308@code{continue} is ignored.
3309
d4f3574e
SS
3310The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3311debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3312purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3313@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3314@end table
3315
3316To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3317(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3318calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3319different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3320
3321A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3322(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3323beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3324is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3325and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3326interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3327
3328@table @code
3329@kindex step
41afff9a 3330@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3331@item step
3332Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3333line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3334abbreviated @code{s}.
3335
3336@quotation
3337@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3338@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3339@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3340@c distinction here.
3341@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3342within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3343execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3344debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3345is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3346without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3347below.
3348@end quotation
3349
4a92d011
EZ
3350The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3351line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3352@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3353to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3354the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3355called within the line.
c906108c 3356
d4f3574e
SS
3357Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3358number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3359@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3360on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3361was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3362
3363@item step @var{count}
3364Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3365breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3366@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3367
3368@kindex next
41afff9a 3369@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3370@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3371Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3372This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3373the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3374control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3375that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3376is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3377
3378An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3379
3380
3381@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3382@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3383@c
3384@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3385@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3386@c function are executed without stopping.
3387
d4f3574e
SS
3388The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3389source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3390@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3391
b90a5f51
CF
3392@kindex set step-mode
3393@item set step-mode
3394@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3395@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3396@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3397The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3398stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3399information rather than stepping over it.
3400
4a92d011
EZ
3401This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3402machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3403want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3404
3405@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3406Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3407debug information. This is the default.
3408
c906108c
SS
3409@kindex finish
3410@item finish
3411Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3412returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3413
3414Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3415,Returning from a function}).
3416
3417@kindex until
41afff9a 3418@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3419@item until
3420@itemx u
3421Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3422current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3423stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3424command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3425automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3426than the address of the jump.
3427
3428This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3429though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3430exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3431simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3432through the next iteration.
3433
3434@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3435stack frame.
3436
3437@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3438of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3439example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3440(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3441@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3442
474c8240 3443@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3444(@value{GDBP}) f
3445#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3446206 expand_input();
3447(@value{GDBP}) until
3448195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3449@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3450
3451This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3452generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3453start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3454written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3455to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3456expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3457statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3458
3459@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3460instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3461argument.
3462
3463@item until @var{location}
3464@itemx u @var{location}
3465Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3466reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3467the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
c60eb6f1
EZ
3468,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3469hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3470location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3471implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3472invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3473line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3474line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3475invocations have returned.
3476
3477@smallexample
347894 int factorial (int value)
347995 @{
348096 if (value > 1) @{
348197 value *= factorial (value - 1);
348298 @}
348399 return (value);
3484100 @}
3485@end smallexample
3486
3487
3488@kindex advance @var{location}
3489@itemx advance @var{location}
3490Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3491required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3492command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3493frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3494not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3495have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3496
c906108c
SS
3497
3498@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3499@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3500@item stepi
96a2c332 3501@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3502@itemx si
3503Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3504
3505It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3506instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3507instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3508Display,, Automatic display}.
3509
3510An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3511
3512@need 750
3513@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3514@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3515@item nexti
96a2c332 3516@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3517@itemx ni
3518Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3519proceed until the function returns.
3520
3521An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3522@end table
3523
6d2ebf8b 3524@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3525@section Signals
3526@cindex signals
3527
3528A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3529operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3530kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3531signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3532@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3533memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3534the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3535requested an alarm).
3536
3537@cindex fatal signals
3538Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3539functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3540errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3541program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3542@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3543fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3544
3545@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3546program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3547signal.
3548
3549@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3550Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3551@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3552(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3553but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3554You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3555
3556@table @code
3557@kindex info signals
3558@item info signals
96a2c332 3559@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3560Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3561handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3562the defined types of signals.
3563
d4f3574e 3564@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3565
3566@kindex handle
3567@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3568Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3569can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3570@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3571@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3572known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3573@end table
3574
3575@c @group
3576The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3577Their full names are:
3578
3579@table @code
3580@item nostop
3581@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3582still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3583
3584@item stop
3585@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3586the @code{print} keyword as well.
3587
3588@item print
3589@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3590
3591@item noprint
3592@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3593implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3594
3595@item pass
5ece1a18 3596@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3597@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3598can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3599and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3600
3601@item nopass
5ece1a18 3602@itemx ignore
c906108c 3603@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3604@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3605@end table
3606@c @end group
3607
d4f3574e
SS
3608When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3609program until you
c906108c
SS
3610continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3611effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3612after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3613command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3614program sees that signal when you continue.
3615
24f93129
EZ
3616The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3617non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3618@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3619erroneous signals.
3620
c906108c
SS
3621You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3622seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3623or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3624due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3625values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3626execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3627a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3628you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3629program a signal}.
c906108c 3630
6d2ebf8b 3631@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3632@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3633
3634When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3635programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3636breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3637
3638@table @code
3639@cindex breakpoints and threads
3640@cindex thread breakpoints
3641@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3642@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3643@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3644@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3645writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3646
3647Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3648to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3649particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3650numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3651column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3652
3653If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3654breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3655program.
3656
3657You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3658well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3659breakpoint condition, like this:
3660
3661@smallexample
2df3850c 3662(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3663@end smallexample
3664
3665@end table
3666
3667@cindex stopped threads
3668@cindex threads, stopped
3669Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3670@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3671allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3672switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3673underfoot.
3674
3675@cindex continuing threads
3676@cindex threads, continuing
3677Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3678executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3679like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3680
3681In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3682Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3683system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3684execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3685single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3686statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3687stops.
3688
3689You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3690continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3691thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3692first thread completes whatever you requested.
3693
3694On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3695thread to run.
3696
3697@table @code
3698@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3699Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3700locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3701current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3702mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3703``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3704stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3705when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3706function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3707like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3708thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3709@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3710
3711@item show scheduler-locking
3712Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3713@end table
3714
c906108c 3715
6d2ebf8b 3716@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3717@chapter Examining the Stack
3718
3719When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3720stopped and how it got there.
3721
3722@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3723Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3724is generated.
3725That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3726the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3727and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3728The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3729The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3730stack}.
3731
3732When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3733stack allow you to see all of this information.
3734
3735@cindex selected frame
3736One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3737@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3738particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3739your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3740special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3741interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3742
3743When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3744currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3745@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3746
3747@menu
3748* Frames:: Stack frames
3749* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3750* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3751* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3752
3753@end menu
3754
6d2ebf8b 3755@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3756@section Stack frames
3757
d4f3574e 3758@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3759@cindex stack frame
3760The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3761frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3762with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3763to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3764which the function is executing.
3765
3766@cindex initial frame
3767@cindex outermost frame
3768@cindex innermost frame
3769When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3770function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3771@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3772made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3773is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3774the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3775actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3776recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3777
3778@cindex frame pointer
3779Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3780stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3781kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3782address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3783in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3784going on in that frame.
3785
3786@cindex frame number
3787@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3788zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3789and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3790they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3791frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3792
6d2ebf8b
SS
3793@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3794@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3795@cindex frameless execution
3796Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3797without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3798@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3799@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3800@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3801generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3802This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3803the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3804with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3805has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3806it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3807correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3808no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3809
3810@table @code
d4f3574e 3811@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3812@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3813@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3814The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3815and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3816address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3817@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3818
3819@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3820@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3821@item select-frame
3822The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3823to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3824@code{frame}.
3825@end table
3826
6d2ebf8b 3827@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3828@section Backtraces
3829
3830@cindex backtraces
3831@cindex tracebacks
3832@cindex stack traces
3833A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3834line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3835frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3836stack.
3837
3838@table @code
3839@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3840@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3841@item backtrace
3842@itemx bt
3843Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3844frames in the stack.
3845
3846You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3847character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3848
3849@item backtrace @var{n}
3850@itemx bt @var{n}
3851Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3852
3853@item backtrace -@var{n}
3854@itemx bt -@var{n}
3855Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3856@end table
3857
3858@kindex where
3859@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3860@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3861The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3862are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3863
3864Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3865The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3866print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3867line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3868counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3869line number.
3870
3871Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3872@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3873
3874@smallexample
3875@group
5d161b24 3876#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3877 at builtin.c:993
3878#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3879#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3880 at macro.c:71
3881(More stack frames follow...)
3882@end group
3883@end smallexample
3884
3885@noindent
3886The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3887value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3888code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3889
b4e9345d
DJ
3890@kindex set backtrace-below-main
3891@kindex show backtrace-below-main
3892
95f90d25
DJ
3893Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3894and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3895When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3896the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3897uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3898change this behavior.
3899
3900@table @code
3901@item set backtrace-below-main off
3902Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3903default.
3904
3905@item set backtrace-below-main
3906@itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3907Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3908
3909@item show backtrace-below-main
3910Display the current backtrace policy.
3911@end table
3912
6d2ebf8b 3913@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3914@section Selecting a frame
3915
3916Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3917whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3918selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3919of the stack frame just selected.
3920
3921@table @code
d4f3574e 3922@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3923@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3924@item frame @var{n}
3925@itemx f @var{n}
3926Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3927(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3928innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3929@code{main}.
3930
3931@item frame @var{addr}
3932@itemx f @var{addr}
3933Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3934chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3935impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3936addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3937switches between them.
3938
c906108c
SS
3939On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3940select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3941
3942On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3943pointer and a program counter.
3944
3945On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3946pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3947@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3948@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3949@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3950
3951@kindex up
3952@item up @var{n}
3953Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3954advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3955that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3956
3957@kindex down
41afff9a 3958@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3959@item down @var{n}
3960Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3961advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3962that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3963abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3964@end table
3965
3966All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3967frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3968arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3969frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3970
3971@need 1000
3972For example:
3973
3974@smallexample
3975@group
3976(@value{GDBP}) up
3977#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3978 at env.c:10
397910 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3980@end group
3981@end smallexample
3982
3983After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3984prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3985You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3986editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3987@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3988for details.
c906108c
SS
3989
3990@table @code
3991@kindex down-silently
3992@kindex up-silently
3993@item up-silently @var{n}
3994@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3995These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3996respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3997causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3998in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3999distracting.
4000@end table
4001
6d2ebf8b 4002@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
4003@section Information about a frame
4004
4005There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4006stack frame.
4007
4008@table @code
4009@item frame
4010@itemx f
4011When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4012frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4013selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4014argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4015@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4016
4017@kindex info frame
41afff9a 4018@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
4019@item info frame
4020@itemx info f
4021This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4022including:
4023
4024@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
4025@item
4026the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
4027@item
4028the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4029@item
4030the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4031@item
4032the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4033@item
4034the address of the frame's arguments
4035@item
d4f3574e
SS
4036the address of the frame's local variables
4037@item
c906108c
SS
4038the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4039@item
4040which registers were saved in the frame
4041@end itemize
4042
4043@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4044something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4045the usual conventions.
4046
4047@item info frame @var{addr}
4048@itemx info f @var{addr}
4049Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4050selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4051command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4052architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4053@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4054
4055@kindex info args
4056@item info args
4057Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4058
4059@item info locals
4060@kindex info locals
4061Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4062line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4063accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4064
c906108c 4065@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4066@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4067@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4068@item info catch
4069Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4070current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4071exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4072@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4073@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4074
c906108c
SS
4075@end table
4076
c906108c 4077
6d2ebf8b 4078@node Source
c906108c
SS
4079@chapter Examining Source Files
4080
4081@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4082information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4083used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4084the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4085(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4086execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4087source files by explicit command.
4088
7a292a7a 4089If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4090prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4091@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4092
4093@menu
4094* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4095* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4096* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4097* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4098* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4099@end menu
4100
6d2ebf8b 4101@node List
c906108c
SS
4102@section Printing source lines
4103
4104@kindex list
41afff9a 4105@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4106To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4107(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4108There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4109
4110Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4111
4112@table @code
4113@item list @var{linenum}
4114Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4115current source file.
4116
4117@item list @var{function}
4118Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4119@var{function}.
4120
4121@item list
4122Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4123@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4124printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4125as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4126Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4127
4128@item list -
4129Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4130@end table
4131
4132By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4133the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4134
4135@table @code
4136@kindex set listsize
4137@item set listsize @var{count}
4138Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4139the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4140
4141@kindex show listsize
4142@item show listsize
4143Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4144@end table
4145
4146Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4147so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4148than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4149argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4150each repetition moves up in the source file.
4151
4152@cindex linespec
4153In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4154@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4155of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4156Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4157
4158@table @code
4159@item list @var{linespec}
4160Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4161
4162@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4163Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4164linespecs.
4165
4166@item list ,@var{last}
4167Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4168
4169@item list @var{first},
4170Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4171
4172@item list +
4173Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4174
4175@item list -
4176Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4177
4178@item list
4179As described in the preceding table.
4180@end table
4181
4182Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4183kinds of linespec.
4184
4185@table @code
4186@item @var{number}
4187Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4188When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4189the same source file as the first linespec.
4190
4191@item +@var{offset}
4192Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4193When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4194two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4195first linespec.
4196
4197@item -@var{offset}
4198Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4199
4200@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4201Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4202
4203@item @var{function}
4204Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4205For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4206
4207@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4208Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4209function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4210file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4211identically named functions in different source files.
4212
4213@item *@var{address}
4214Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4215@var{address} may be any expression.
4216@end table
4217
87885426
FN
4218@node Edit
4219@section Editing source files
4220@cindex editing source files
4221
4222@kindex edit
4223@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4224To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4225The editing program of your choice
4226is invoked with the current line set to
4227the active line in the program.
4228Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4229want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4230
4231Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4232
4233@table @code
4234@item edit
4235Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4236
4237@item edit @var{number}
4238Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4239
4240@item edit @var{function}
4241Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4242
4243@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4244Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4245
4246@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4247Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4248function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4249file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4250identically named functions in different source files.
4251
4252@item edit *@var{address}
4253Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4254@var{address} may be any expression.
4255@end table
4256
4257@subsection Choosing your editor
4258You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4259@footnote{
4260The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4261following command-line syntax:
10998722 4262@smallexample
87885426 4263ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4264@end smallexample
4265The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4266the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4267by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4268@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4269@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4270@smallexample
87885426
FN
4271EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4272export EDITOR
4273gdb ...
10998722 4274@end smallexample
87885426 4275or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4276@smallexample
87885426
FN
4277setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4278gdb ...
10998722 4279@end smallexample
87885426 4280
6d2ebf8b 4281@node Search
c906108c
SS
4282@section Searching source files
4283@cindex searching
4284@kindex reverse-search
4285
4286There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4287regular expression.
4288
4289@table @code
4290@kindex search
4291@kindex forward-search
4292@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4293@itemx search @var{regexp}
4294The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4295starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4296@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4297synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4298@code{fo}.
4299
4300@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4301The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4302with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4303for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4304this command as @code{rev}.
4305@end table
c906108c 4306
6d2ebf8b 4307@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4308@section Specifying source directories
4309
4310@cindex source path
4311@cindex directories for source files
4312Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4313files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4314the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4315session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4316this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4317it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4318in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4319the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4320the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4321path.
4322
4323If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4324object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4325too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4326compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4327last resort.
4328
4329Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4330any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4331each line is in the file.
4332
4333@kindex directory
4334@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4335When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4336and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4337To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4338
4339@table @code
4340@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4341@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4342Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4343directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4344(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4345part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4346whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4347path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4348
4349@kindex cdir
4350@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4351@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4352@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4353@cindex compilation directory
4354@cindex current directory
4355@cindex working directory
4356@cindex directory, current
4357@cindex directory, compilation
4358You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4359directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4360working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4361tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4362session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4363directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4364
4365@item directory
4366Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4367
4368@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4369@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4370
4371@item show directories
4372@kindex show directories
4373Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4374@end table
4375
4376If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4377interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4378versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4379
4380@enumerate
4381@item
4382Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4383
4384@item
4385Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4386directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4387directories in one command.
4388@end enumerate
4389
6d2ebf8b 4390@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4391@section Source and machine code
4392
4393You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4394addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4395a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4396mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4397line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4398well as hex.
4399
4400@table @code
4401@kindex info line
4402@item info line @var{linespec}
4403Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4404source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4405the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4406source lines}).
4407@end table
4408
4409For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4410the object code for the first line of function
4411@code{m4_changequote}:
4412
d4f3574e
SS
4413@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4414@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4415@smallexample
96a2c332 4416(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4417Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4418@end smallexample
4419
4420@noindent
4421We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4422@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4423@smallexample
4424(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4425Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4426@end smallexample
4427
4428@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4429@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4430After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4431is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4432sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4433,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4434convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4435variables}).
4436
4437@table @code
4438@kindex disassemble
4439@cindex assembly instructions
4440@cindex instructions, assembly
4441@cindex machine instructions
4442@cindex listing machine instructions
4443@item disassemble
4444This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4445instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4446program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4447command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4448surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4449(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4450@end table
4451
c906108c
SS
4452The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4453HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4454
4455@smallexample
4456(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4457Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44580x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44590x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44600x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44610x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44620x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44630x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44640x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44650x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4466End of assembler dump.
4467@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4468
4469Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4470mnemonics or other syntax.
4471
4472@table @code
d4f3574e 4473@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4474@cindex assembly instructions
4475@cindex instructions, assembly
4476@cindex machine instructions
4477@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4478@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4479@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4480@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4481Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4482program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4483
4484Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4485can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4486The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4487assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4488@end table
4489
4490
6d2ebf8b 4491@node Data
c906108c
SS
4492@chapter Examining Data
4493
4494@cindex printing data
4495@cindex examining data
4496@kindex print
4497@kindex inspect
4498@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4499@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4500@c different window or something like that.
4501The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4502command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4503evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4504program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4505Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4506
4507@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4508@item print @var{expr}
4509@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4510@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4511value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4512you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4513@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4514formats}.
4515
4516@item print
4517@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4518If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4519@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4520conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4521@end table
4522
4523A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4524It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4525specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4526
7a292a7a 4527If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4528fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4529command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4530Table}.
c906108c
SS
4531
4532@menu
4533* Expressions:: Expressions
4534* Variables:: Program variables
4535* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4536* Output Formats:: Output formats
4537* Memory:: Examining memory
4538* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4539* Print Settings:: Print settings
4540* Value History:: Value history
4541* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4542* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4543* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4544* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4545* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4546* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4547* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4548 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4549@end menu
4550
6d2ebf8b 4551@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4552@section Expressions
4553
4554@cindex expressions
4555@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4556compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4557by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4558@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4559casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4560you compiled your program to include this information; see
4561@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4562
d4f3574e
SS
4563@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4564the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4565you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4566memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4567
c906108c
SS
4568Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4569this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4570Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4571languages.
4572
4573In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4574expressions regardless of your programming language.
4575
4576Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4577useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4578at that address in memory.
4579@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4580
4581@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4582to programming languages:
4583
4584@table @code
4585@item @@
4586@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4587@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4588
4589@item ::
4590@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4591function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4592
4593@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4594@cindex type casting memory
4595@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4596@cindex casts, to view memory
4597@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4598Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4599memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4600pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4601a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4602normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4603@end table
4604
6d2ebf8b 4605@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4606@section Program variables
4607
4608The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4609in your program.
4610
4611Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4612(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4613
4614@itemize @bullet
4615@item
4616global (or file-static)
4617@end itemize
4618
5d161b24 4619@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4620
4621@itemize @bullet
4622@item
4623visible according to the scope rules of the
4624programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4625@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4626
4627@noindent This means that in the function
4628
474c8240 4629@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4630foo (a)
4631 int a;
4632@{
4633 bar (a);
4634 @{
4635 int b = test ();
4636 bar (b);
4637 @}
4638@}
474c8240 4639@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4640
4641@noindent
4642you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4643executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4644examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4645the block where @code{b} is declared.
4646
4647@cindex variable name conflict
4648There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4649scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4650in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4651function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4652happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4653you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4654using the colon-colon notation:
4655
d4f3574e 4656@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4657@iftex
4658@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4659@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4660@end iftex
474c8240 4661@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4662@var{file}::@var{variable}
4663@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4664@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4665
4666@noindent
4667Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4668static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4669make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4670to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4671
474c8240 4672@smallexample
c906108c 4673(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4674@end smallexample
c906108c 4675
b37052ae 4676@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4677This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4678use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4679scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4680@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4681@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4682
4683@cindex wrong values
4684@cindex variable values, wrong
4685@quotation
4686@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4687wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4688scope, and just before exit.
4689@end quotation
4690You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4691This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4692set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4693stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4694values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4695also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4696after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4697variable definitions may be gone.
4698
4699This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4700To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4701when compiling.
4702
d4f3574e
SS
4703@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4704Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4705unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4706opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4707offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4708might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4709happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4710
474c8240 4711@smallexample
d4f3574e 4712No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4713@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4714
4715To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4716different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
0179ffac
DC
4717formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4718usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4719produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4720COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4721an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4722for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
d4f3574e
SS
4723
4724
6d2ebf8b 4725@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4726@section Artificial arrays
4727
4728@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4729@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4730It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4731same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4732dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4733program.
4734
4735You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4736@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4737operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4738and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4739of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4740the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4741argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4742following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4743example. If a program says
4744
474c8240 4745@smallexample
c906108c 4746int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4747@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4748
4749@noindent
4750you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4751
474c8240 4752@smallexample
c906108c 4753p *array@@len
474c8240 4754@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4755
4756The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4757with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4758subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4759Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4760(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4761
4762Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4763This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4764The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4765@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4766(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4767$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4768@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4769
4770As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4771@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4772the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4773@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4774(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4775$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4776@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4777
4778Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4779moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4780actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4781of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4782to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4783variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4784interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4785instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4786structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4787in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4788
474c8240 4789@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4790set $i = 0
4791p dtab[$i++]->fv
4792@key{RET}
4793@key{RET}
4794@dots{}
474c8240 4795@end smallexample
c906108c 4796
6d2ebf8b 4797@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4798@section Output formats
4799
4800@cindex formatted output
4801@cindex output formats
4802By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4803this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4804in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4805at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4806these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4807
4808The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4809already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4810@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4811letters supported are:
4812
4813@table @code
4814@item x
4815Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4816hexadecimal.
4817
4818@item d
4819Print as integer in signed decimal.
4820
4821@item u
4822Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4823
4824@item o
4825Print as integer in octal.
4826
4827@item t
4828Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4829@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4830used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4831see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4832
4833@item a
4834@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4835@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4836Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4837the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4838where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4839
474c8240 4840@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4841(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4842$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4843@end smallexample
c906108c 4844
3d67e040
EZ
4845@noindent
4846The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4847@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4848
c906108c
SS
4849@item c
4850Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4851
4852@item f
4853Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4854using typical floating point syntax.
4855@end table
4856
4857For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4858
474c8240 4859@smallexample
c906108c 4860p/x $pc
474c8240 4861@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4862
4863@noindent
4864Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4865names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4866
4867To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4868you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4869expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4870
6d2ebf8b 4871@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4872@section Examining memory
4873
4874You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4875any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4876
4877@cindex examining memory
4878@table @code
41afff9a 4879@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4880@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4881@itemx x @var{addr}
4882@itemx x
4883Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4884@end table
4885
4886@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4887much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4888expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4889If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4890Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4891
4892@table @r
4893@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4894The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4895how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4896@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4897@c 4.1.2.
4898
4899@item @var{f}, the display format
4900The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4901@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4902The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4903The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4904
4905@item @var{u}, the unit size
4906The unit size is any of
4907
4908@table @code
4909@item b
4910Bytes.
4911@item h
4912Halfwords (two bytes).
4913@item w
4914Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4915@item g
4916Giant words (eight bytes).
4917@end table
4918
4919Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4920default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4921@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4922
4923@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4924@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4925memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4926it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4927@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4928@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4929other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4930the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4931starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4932a value from memory).
4933@end table
4934
4935For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4936(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4937starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4938words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4939@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4940
4941Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4942letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4943unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4944specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4945(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4946
4947Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4948and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4949@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4950including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4951alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4952Code,,Source and machine code}.
4953
4954All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4955easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4956you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4957instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4958with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4959the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4960for successive uses of @code{x}.
4961
4962@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4963The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4964in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4965would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4966subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4967@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4968examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4969@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4970the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4971
4972If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4973are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4974address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4975
6d2ebf8b 4976@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4977@section Automatic display
4978@cindex automatic display
4979@cindex display of expressions
4980
4981If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4982(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4983display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4984Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4985to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4986The automatic display looks like this:
4987
474c8240 4988@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49892: foo = 38
49903: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4991@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4992
4993@noindent
4994This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4995displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4996specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4997whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4998format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4999or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5000supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5001
5002@table @code
5003@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
5004@item display @var{expr}
5005Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
5006each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5007
5008@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5009
d4f3574e 5010@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 5011For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 5012count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
5013arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5014@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5015
5016@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5017For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5018number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5019be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5020doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5021@end table
5022
5023For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5024instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 5025is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5026
5027@table @code
5028@kindex delete display
5029@kindex undisplay
5030@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5031@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5032Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5033
5034@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5035(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5036
5037@kindex disable display
5038@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5039Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5040item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5041enabled again later.
5042
5043@kindex enable display
5044@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5045Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5046again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5047
5048@item display
5049Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5050done when your program stops.
5051
5052@kindex info display
5053@item info display
5054Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5055automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5056values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5057It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5058because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5059@end table
5060
5061If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5062sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5063expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5064variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5065@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5066@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5067continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5068there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5069automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5070is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5071
6d2ebf8b 5072@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5073@section Print settings
5074
5075@cindex format options
5076@cindex print settings
5077@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5078and symbols are printed.
5079
5080@noindent
5081These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5082
5083@table @code
5084@kindex set print address
5085@item set print address
5086@itemx set print address on
5087@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5088traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5089even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5090is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5091@code{set print address on}:
5092
5093@smallexample
5094@group
5095(@value{GDBP}) f
5096#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5097 at input.c:530
5098530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5099@end group
5100@end smallexample
5101
5102@item set print address off
5103Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5104this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5105
5106@smallexample
5107@group
5108(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5109(@value{GDBP}) f
5110#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5111530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5112@end group
5113@end smallexample
5114
5115You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5116dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5117@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5118all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5119
5120@kindex show print address
5121@item show print address
5122Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5123@end table
5124
5125When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5126closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5127identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5128source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5129@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5130you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5131it prints a symbolic address:
5132
5133@table @code
5134@kindex set print symbol-filename
5135@item set print symbol-filename on
5136Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5137symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5138
5139@item set print symbol-filename off
5140Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5141default.
5142
5143@kindex show print symbol-filename
5144@item show print symbol-filename
5145Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5146line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5147@end table
5148
5149Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5150numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5151number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5152
5153Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5154printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5155
5156@table @code
5157@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5158@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5159Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5160offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5161@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5162to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5163
5164@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5165@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5166Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5167symbolic address.
5168@end table
5169
5170@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5171@cindex pointer, finding referent
5172If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5173@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5174and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5175@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5176For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5177at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5178
474c8240 5179@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5180(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5181(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5182$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5183@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5184
5185@quotation
5186@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5187does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5188the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5189@end quotation
5190
5191Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5192
5193@table @code
5194@kindex set print array
5195@item set print array
5196@itemx set print array on
5197Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5198but uses more space. The default is off.
5199
5200@item set print array off
5201Return to compressed format for arrays.
5202
5203@kindex show print array
5204@item show print array
5205Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5206arrays.
5207
5208@kindex set print elements
5209@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5210Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5211If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5212printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5213This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5214When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5215Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5216
5217@kindex show print elements
5218@item show print elements
5219Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5220If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5221
5222@kindex set print null-stop
5223@item set print null-stop
5224Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5225@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5226contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5227The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5228
5229@kindex set print pretty
5230@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5231Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5232per line, like this:
5233
5234@smallexample
5235@group
5236$1 = @{
5237 next = 0x0,
5238 flags = @{
5239 sweet = 1,
5240 sour = 1
5241 @},
5242 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5243@}
5244@end group
5245@end smallexample
5246
5247@item set print pretty off
5248Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5249
5250@smallexample
5251@group
5252$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5253meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5254@end group
5255@end smallexample
5256
5257@noindent
5258This is the default format.
5259
5260@kindex show print pretty
5261@item show print pretty
5262Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5263
5264@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5265@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5266Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5267@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5268character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5269best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5270high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5271
5272@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5273Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5274international character sets, and is the default.
5275
5276@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5277@item show print sevenbit-strings
5278Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5279
5280@kindex set print union
5281@item set print union on
5d161b24 5282Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5283is the default setting.
5284
5285@item set print union off
5286Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5287
5288@kindex show print union
5289@item show print union
5290Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5291structures.
5292
5293For example, given the declarations
5294
5295@smallexample
5296typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5297typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5298typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5299 Bug_forms;
5300
5301struct thing @{
5302 Species it;
5303 union @{
5304 Tree_forms tree;
5305 Bug_forms bug;
5306 @} form;
5307@};
5308
5309struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5310@end smallexample
5311
5312@noindent
5313with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5314
5315@smallexample
5316$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5317@end smallexample
5318
5319@noindent
5320and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5321
5322@smallexample
5323$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5324@end smallexample
5325@end table
5326
c906108c
SS
5327@need 1000
5328@noindent
b37052ae 5329These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5330
5331@table @code
5332@cindex demangling
5333@kindex set print demangle
5334@item set print demangle
5335@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5336Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5337(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5338linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5339
5340@kindex show print demangle
5341@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5342Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5343
5344@kindex set print asm-demangle
5345@item set print asm-demangle
5346@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5347Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5348in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5349The default is off.
5350
5351@kindex show print asm-demangle
5352@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5353Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5354or demangled form.
5355
5356@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5357@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5358@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5359@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5360Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5361represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5362
5363@table @code
5364@item auto
5365Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5366
5367@item gnu
b37052ae 5368Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5369This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5370
5371@item hp
b37052ae 5372Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5373
5374@item lucid
b37052ae 5375Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5376
5377@item arm
b37052ae 5378Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5379@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5380debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5381require further enhancement to permit that.
5382
5383@end table
5384If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5385
5386@kindex show demangle-style
5387@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5388Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5389
5390@kindex set print object
5391@item set print object
5392@itemx set print object on
5393When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5394(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5395the virtual function table.
5396
5397@item set print object off
5398Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5399virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5400
5401@kindex show print object
5402@item show print object
5403Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5404
5405@kindex set print static-members
5406@item set print static-members
5407@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5408Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5409
5410@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5411Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5412
5413@kindex show print static-members
5414@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5415Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5416
5417@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5418@kindex set print vtbl
5419@item set print vtbl
5420@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5421Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5422(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5423ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5424
5425@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5426Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5427
5428@kindex show print vtbl
5429@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5430Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5431@end table
c906108c 5432
6d2ebf8b 5433@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5434@section Value history
5435
5436@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5437Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5438@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5439Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5440(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5441When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5442since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5443symbol table.
5444
5445@cindex @code{$}
5446@cindex @code{$$}
5447@cindex history number
5448The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5449refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5450@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5451printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5452history number.
5453
5454To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5455history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5456remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5457the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5458@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5459is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5460@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5461
5462For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5463want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5464
474c8240 5465@smallexample
c906108c 5466p *$
474c8240 5467@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5468
5469If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5470to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5471
474c8240 5472@smallexample
c906108c 5473p *$.next
474c8240 5474@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5475
5476@noindent
5477You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5478command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5479
5480Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5481@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5482
474c8240 5483@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5484print x
5485set x=5
474c8240 5486@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5487
5488@noindent
5489then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5490remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5491
5492@table @code
5493@kindex show values
5494@item show values
5495Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5496This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5497values} does not change the history.
5498
5499@item show values @var{n}
5500Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5501
5502@item show values +
5503Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5504values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5505@end table
5506
5507Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5508same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5509
6d2ebf8b 5510@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5511@section Convenience variables
5512
5513@cindex convenience variables
5514@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5515@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5516exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5517setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5518of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5519
5520Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5521@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5522the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5523(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5524by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5525
5526You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5527expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5528For example:
5529
474c8240 5530@smallexample
c906108c 5531set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5532@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5533
5534@noindent
5535would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5536@code{object_ptr}.
5537
5538Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5539value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5540value with another assignment at any time.
5541
5542Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5543variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5544that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5545variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5546
5547@table @code
5548@kindex show convenience
5549@item show convenience
5550Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5551Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5552@end table
5553
5554One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5555incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5556a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5557
474c8240 5558@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5559set $i = 0
5560print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5561@end smallexample
c906108c 5562
d4f3574e
SS
5563@noindent
5564Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5565
5566Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5567values likely to be useful.
5568
5569@table @code
41afff9a 5570@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5571@item $_
5572The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5573the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5574commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5575set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5576and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5577except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5578to the type of @code{$__}.
5579
41afff9a 5580@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5581@item $__
5582The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5583to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5584to match the format in which the data was printed.
5585
5586@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5587@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5588The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5589the program being debugged terminates.
5590@end table
5591
53a5351d
JM
5592On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5593begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5594name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5595
6d2ebf8b 5596@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5597@section Registers
5598
5599@cindex registers
5600You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5601with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5602for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5603your machine.
5604
5605@table @code
5606@kindex info registers
5607@item info registers
5608Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5609and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5610
5611@kindex info all-registers
5612@cindex floating point registers
5613@item info all-registers
5614Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5615and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5616
5617@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5618Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5619As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5620the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5621the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5622@end table
5623
5624@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5625expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5626architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5627@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5628the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5629pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5630register that contains the processor status. For example,
5631you could print the program counter in hex with
5632
474c8240 5633@smallexample
c906108c 5634p/x $pc
474c8240 5635@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5636
5637@noindent
5638or print the instruction to be executed next with
5639
474c8240 5640@smallexample
c906108c 5641x/i $pc
474c8240 5642@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5643
5644@noindent
5645or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5646one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5647memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5648stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5649stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5650regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5651see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5652
474c8240 5653@smallexample
c906108c 5654set $sp += 4
474c8240 5655@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5656
5657Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5658your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5659so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5660shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5661registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5662can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5663is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5664
5665@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5666integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5667special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5668registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5669to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5670(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5671@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5672
5673Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5674means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5675the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5676sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5677coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5678programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5679cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5680that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5681prints the data in both formats.
5682
5683Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5684(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5685value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5686were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5687true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5688frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5689
5690However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5691code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5692@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5693frame makes no difference.
5694
6d2ebf8b 5695@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5696@section Floating point hardware
5697@cindex floating point
5698
5699Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5700you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5701
5702@table @code
5703@kindex info float
5704@item info float
5705Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5706point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5707floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5708the ARM and x86 machines.
5709@end table
c906108c 5710
e76f1f2e
AC
5711@node Vector Unit
5712@section Vector Unit
5713@cindex vector unit
5714
5715Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5716more information about the status of the vector unit.
5717
5718@table @code
5719@kindex info vector
5720@item info vector
5721Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5722layout vary depending on the hardware.
5723@end table
5724
29e57380 5725@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5726@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5727@cindex memory region attributes
5728
5729@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5730required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5731to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5732use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5733
5734Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5735memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5736accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5737been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5738all memory.
5739
5740When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5741to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5742
5743@table @code
5744@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5745@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5746Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5747attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5748special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5749(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5750
5751@kindex delete mem
5752@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5753Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5754
5755@kindex disable mem
5756@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5757Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5758A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5759It may be enabled again later.
5760
5761@kindex enable mem
5762@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5763Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5764
5765@kindex info mem
5766@item info mem
5767Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5768for each region.
5769
5770@table @emph
5771@item Memory Region Number
5772@item Enabled or Disabled.
5773Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5774Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5775
5776@item Lo Address
5777The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5778
5779@item Hi Address
5780The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5781
5782@item Attributes
5783The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5784@end table
5785@end table
5786
5787
5788@subsection Attributes
5789
5790@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5791The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5792write accesses to a memory region.
5793
5794While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5795memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5796etc. from accessing memory.
5797
5798@table @code
5799@item ro
5800Memory is read only.
5801@item wo
5802Memory is write only.
5803@item rw
6ca652b0 5804Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5805@end table
5806
5807@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5808The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5809accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5810require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5811specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5812
5813@table @code
5814@item 8
5815Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5816@item 16
5817Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5818@item 32
5819Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5820@item 64
5821Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5822@end table
5823
5824@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5825@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5826@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5827@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5828@c
5829@c @table @code
5830@c @item hwbreak
5831@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5832@c @item swbreak (default)
5833@c @end table
5834
5835@subsubsection Data Cache
5836The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5837memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5838protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5839does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5840registers.
5841
5842@table @code
5843@item cache
5844Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5845@item nocache
5846Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5847@end table
5848
5849@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5850@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5851@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5852@c
5853@c @table @code
5854@c @item verify
5855@c @item noverify (default)
5856@c @end table
5857
16d9dec6
MS
5858@node Dump/Restore Files
5859@section Copy between memory and a file
5860@cindex dump/restore files
5861@cindex append data to a file
5862@cindex dump data to a file
5863@cindex restore data from a file
5864@kindex dump
5865@kindex append
5866@kindex restore
5867
5868The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5869for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5870into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5871file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5872intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5873
5874@table @code
5875@kindex dump binary
5876@kindex append binary
5877@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5878Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5879raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5880
5881@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5882Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5883raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5884
5885@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5886Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5887
5888@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5889Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5890
5891@kindex dump ihex
5892@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5893Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5894intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5895
5896@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5897Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5898
5899@kindex dump srec
5900@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5901Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5902srec format file @var{filename}.
5903
5904@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5905Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5906
5907@kindex dump tekhex
5908@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5909Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5910tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5911
5912@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5913Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5914
42f9b0a5 5915@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5916Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5917command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5918raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5919@var{binary} after the filename.
5920
5921If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5922contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5923they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5924a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5925from that location.
5926
5927If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5928file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5929These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5930the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5931
5932@end table
5933
a0eb71c5
KB
5934@node Character Sets
5935@section Character Sets
5936@cindex character sets
5937@cindex charset
5938@cindex translating between character sets
5939@cindex host character set
5940@cindex target character set
5941
5942If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5943represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5944@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5945you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5946character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5947@dfn{target character set}.
5948
5949For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5950uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5951remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5952running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5953then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5954@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5955target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5956@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5957character and string literals in expressions.
5958
5959@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5960the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5961target-charset} command, described below.
5962
5963Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5964support:
5965
5966@table @code
5967@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5968@kindex set target-charset
5969Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5970character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5971@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5972the character sets it supports.
5973@end table
5974
5975@table @code
5976@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5977@kindex set host-charset
5978Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5979
5980By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5981system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5982@code{set host-charset} command.
5983
5984@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5985set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5986indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5987@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5988character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5989it can use as a host character set.
5990
5991@item set charset @var{charset}
5992@kindex set charset
5993Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5994invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5995character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5996sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5997asterisk (@samp{*}).
5998
5999@item show charset
6000@itemx show host-charset
6001@itemx show target-charset
6002@kindex show charset
6003@kindex show host-charset
6004@kindex show target-charset
6005Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
6006and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
6007charset}.
6008
6009@end table
6010
6011@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6012sets:
6013
6014@table @code
6015
6016@item ASCII
6017@cindex ASCII character set
6018Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6019character set.
6020
6021@item ISO-8859-1
6022@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6023@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6024The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
6025characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6026this as its host character set.
6027
6028@item EBCDIC-US
6029@itemx IBM1047
6030@cindex EBCDIC character set
6031@cindex IBM1047 character set
6032Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6033mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6034@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6035
6036@end table
6037
6038Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6039GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6040encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6041
6042Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6043Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6044@file{charset-test.c}:
6045
6046@smallexample
6047#include <stdio.h>
6048
6049char ascii_hello[]
6050 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6051 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6052char ibm1047_hello[]
6053 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6054 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6055
6056main ()
6057@{
6058 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6059@}
10998722 6060@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6061
6062In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6063containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6064encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6065
6066We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6067
6068@smallexample
6069$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6070$ gdb -nw charset-test
6071GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6072Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6073@dots{}
6074(gdb)
10998722 6075@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6076
6077We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6078@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6079strings:
6080
6081@smallexample
6082(gdb) show charset
6083The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6084(gdb)
10998722 6085@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6086
6087For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6088initial character set:
6089@smallexample
6090(gdb) set charset ascii
6091(gdb) show charset
6092The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6093(gdb)
10998722 6094@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6095
6096Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6097host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6098characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6099them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6100@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6101
6102@smallexample
6103(gdb) print ascii_hello
6104$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6105(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6106$2 = 72 'H'
6107(gdb)
10998722 6108@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6109
6110@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6111literals you use in expressions:
6112
6113@smallexample
6114(gdb) print '+'
6115$3 = 43 '+'
6116(gdb)
10998722 6117@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6118
6119The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6120character.
6121
6122@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6123target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6124character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6125
6126@smallexample
6127(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6128$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6129(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6130$5 = 200 '\310'
6131(gdb)
10998722 6132@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6133
6134If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6135@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6136
6137@smallexample
6138(gdb) set target-charset
6139Valid character sets are:
6140 ascii *
6141 iso-8859-1 *
6142 ebcdic-us
6143 ibm1047
6144* - can be used as a host character set
10998722 6145@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6146
6147We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6148program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6149@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6150target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6151@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6152
6153@smallexample
6154(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6155(gdb) show charset
6156The current host character set is `ascii'.
6157The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6158(gdb) print ascii_hello
6159$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6160(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6161$7 = 72 '\110'
6162(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6163$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6164(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6165$9 = 200 'H'
6166(gdb)
10998722 6167@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6168
6169As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6170string literals you use in expressions:
6171
6172@smallexample
6173(gdb) print '+'
6174$10 = 78 '+'
6175(gdb)
10998722 6176@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6177
6178The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6179character.
6180
6181
e2e0bcd1
JB
6182@node Macros
6183@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6184
6185Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6186``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6187@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6188the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6189where it was defined.
6190
6191You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6192with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6193include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6194with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6195
6196A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6197and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6198points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6199no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6200uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6201@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6202see @ref{List}.
6203
6204At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6205token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6206variable-arity macros.
6207
6208Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6209macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6210the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6211
6212@table @code
6213
6214@kindex macro expand
6215@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6216@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6217@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6218@item macro expand @var{expression}
6219@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6220Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6221@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6222not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6223it can be any string of tokens.
6224
6225@kindex macro expand-once
6226@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6227@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6228@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6229expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6230@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6231left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6232particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6233expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6234parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6235can be any string of tokens.
6236
475b0867 6237@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6238@cindex macro definition, showing
6239@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6240@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6241Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6242source location where that definition was established.
6243
6244@kindex macro define
6245@cindex user-defined macros
6246@cindex defining macros interactively
6247@cindex macros, user-defined
6248@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6249@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6250@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6251preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6252by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6253command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6254second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6255given in @var{arglist}.
6256
6257A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6258evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6259undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6260definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6261well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6262
6263@kindex macro undef
6264@item macro undef @var{macro}
6265@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6266definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6267definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6268above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6269debugged.
6270
6271@end table
6272
6273@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6274Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6275show our source files:
6276
6277@smallexample
6278$ cat sample.c
6279#include <stdio.h>
6280#include "sample.h"
6281
6282#define M 42
6283#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6284
6285main ()
6286@{
6287#define N 28
6288 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6289#undef N
6290 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6291#define N 1729
6292 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6293@}
6294$ cat sample.h
6295#define Q <
6296$
6297@end smallexample
6298
6299Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6300We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6301compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6302information.
6303
6304@smallexample
6305$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6306$
6307@end smallexample
6308
6309Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6310
6311@smallexample
6312$ gdb -nw sample
6313GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6314Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6315GDB is free software, @dots{}
6316(gdb)
6317@end smallexample
6318
6319We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6320program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6321to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6322
6323@smallexample
6324(gdb) list main
63253
63264 #define M 42
63275 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
63286
63297 main ()
63308 @{
63319 #define N 28
633210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
633311 #undef N
633412 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6335(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6336Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6337#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6338(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6339Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6340 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6341#define Q <
6342(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6343expands to: (42 + 1)
6344(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6345expands to: once (M + 1)
6346(gdb)
6347@end smallexample
6348
6349In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6350the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6351@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6352which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6353
6354Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6355the source line of the current stack frame:
6356
6357@smallexample
6358(gdb) break main
6359Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6360(gdb) run
6361Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6362
6363Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
636410 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6365(gdb)
6366@end smallexample
6367
6368At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6369
6370@smallexample
475b0867 6371(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6372Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6373#define N 28
6374(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6375expands to: 28 < 42
6376(gdb) print N Q M
6377$1 = 1
6378(gdb)
6379@end smallexample
6380
6381As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6382give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6383thereof) in force at each point:
6384
6385@smallexample
6386(gdb) next
6387Hello, world!
638812 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6389(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6390The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6391at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6392(gdb) next
6393We're so creative.
639414 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6395(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6396Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6397#define N 1729
6398(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6399expands to: 1729 < 42
6400(gdb) print N Q M
6401$2 = 0
6402(gdb)
6403@end smallexample
6404
6405
b37052ae
EZ
6406@node Tracepoints
6407@chapter Tracepoints
6408@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6409@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6410
6411@cindex tracepoints
6412In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6413the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6414anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6415depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6416might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6417fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6418to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6419
6420Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6421specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6422arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6423Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6424those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6425expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6426for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6427a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6428in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6429values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6430unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6431
6432The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6433targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6434to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6435stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6436tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6437
6438This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6439
6440@menu
6441* Set Tracepoints::
6442* Analyze Collected Data::
6443* Tracepoint Variables::
6444@end menu
6445
6446@node Set Tracepoints
6447@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6448
6449Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6450tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6451tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6452breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6453one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6454tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6455work on.
6456
6457For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6458of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6459it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6460local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6461commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6462tracepoint was hit.
6463
6464This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6465conditions and actions.
6466
6467@menu
6468* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6469* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6470* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6471* Tracepoint Actions::
6472* Listing Tracepoints::
6473* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6474@end menu
6475
6476@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6477@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6478
6479@table @code
6480@cindex set tracepoint
6481@kindex trace
6482@item trace
6483The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6484Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6485the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6486defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6487debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6488program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6489doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6490cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6491running.
6492
6493Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6494
6495@smallexample
6496(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6497
6498(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6499
6500(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6501
6502(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6503
6504(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6505@end smallexample
6506
6507@noindent
6508You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6509
6510@vindex $tpnum
6511@cindex last tracepoint number
6512@cindex recent tracepoint number
6513@cindex tracepoint number
6514The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6515of the most recently set tracepoint.
6516
6517@kindex delete tracepoint
6518@cindex tracepoint deletion
6519@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6520Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6521default is to delete all tracepoints.
6522
6523Examples:
6524
6525@smallexample
6526(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6527
6528(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6529@end smallexample
6530
6531@noindent
6532You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6533@end table
6534
6535@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6536@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6537
6538@table @code
6539@kindex disable tracepoint
6540@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6541Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6542@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6543the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6544a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6545
6546@kindex enable tracepoint
6547@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6548Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6549tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6550run.
6551@end table
6552
6553@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6554@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6555
6556@table @code
6557@kindex passcount
6558@cindex tracepoint pass count
6559@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6560Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6561automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6562@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6563the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6564@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6565passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6566given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6567user.
6568
6569Examples:
6570
6571@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6572(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6573@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6574
6575(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6576@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6577(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6578(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6579(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6580(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6581(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6582(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6583@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6584@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6585@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6586@end smallexample
6587@end table
6588
6589@node Tracepoint Actions
6590@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6591
6592@table @code
6593@kindex actions
6594@cindex tracepoint actions
6595@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6596This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6597tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6598specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6599recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6600@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6601actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6602terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6603far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6604@code{while-stepping}.
6605
6606@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6607To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6608and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6609
6610@smallexample
6611(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6612
6826cf00 6613(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6614
6826cf00 6615(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6616@end smallexample
6617
6618In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6619commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6620hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6621following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6622followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6623@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6624@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6625@code{end} command.
6626
6627@smallexample
6628(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6629(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6630Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6631> collect bar,baz
6632> collect $regs
6633> while-stepping 12
6634 > collect $fp, $sp
6635 > end
6636end
6637@end smallexample
6638
6639@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6640@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6641Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6642This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6643In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6644special arguments are supported:
6645
6646@table @code
6647@item $regs
6648collect all registers
6649
6650@item $args
6651collect all function arguments
6652
6653@item $locals
6654collect all local variables.
6655@end table
6656
6657You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6658with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6659arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6660
f5c37c66
EZ
6661The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6662particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6663
b37052ae
EZ
6664@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6665@item while-stepping @var{n}
6666Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6667new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6668followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6669its own @code{end} command):
6670
6671@smallexample
6672> while-stepping 12
6673 > collect $regs, myglobal
6674 > end
6675>
6676@end smallexample
6677
6678@noindent
6679You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6680@code{stepping}.
6681@end table
6682
6683@node Listing Tracepoints
6684@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6685
6686@table @code
6687@kindex info tracepoints
6688@cindex information about tracepoints
6689@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6690Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6691a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6692defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6693shown:
6694
6695@itemize @bullet
6696@item
6697its number
6698@item
6699whether it is enabled or disabled
6700@item
6701its address
6702@item
6703its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6704@item
6705its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6706@item
6707where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6708@item
6709its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6710@end itemize
6711
6712@smallexample
6713(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6714Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
67151 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
67162 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
67173 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6718(@value{GDBP})
6719@end smallexample
6720
6721@noindent
6722This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6723@end table
6724
6725@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6726@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6727
6728@table @code
6729@kindex tstart
6730@cindex start a new trace experiment
6731@cindex collected data discarded
6732@item tstart
6733This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6734begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6735the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6736experiment.
6737
6738@kindex tstop
6739@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6740@item tstop
6741This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6742stops collecting data.
6743
6744@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6745automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6746(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6747
6748@kindex tstatus
6749@cindex status of trace data collection
6750@cindex trace experiment, status of
6751@item tstatus
6752This command displays the status of the current trace data
6753collection.
6754@end table
6755
6756Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6757
6758@smallexample
6759(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6760(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6761Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6762> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6763> while-stepping 11
6764 > collect $regs
6765 > end
6766> end
6767(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6768 [time passes @dots{}]
6769(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6770@end smallexample
6771
6772
6773@node Analyze Collected Data
6774@section Using the collected data
6775
6776After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6777for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6778collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6779snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6780consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6781examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6782specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6783snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6784registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6785rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6786debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6787(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6788behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6789when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6790the buffer will fail.
6791
6792@menu
6793* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6794* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6795* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6796@end menu
6797
6798@node tfind
6799@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6800
6801@kindex tfind
6802@cindex select trace snapshot
6803@cindex find trace snapshot
6804The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6805@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6806counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6807snapshot is selected.
6808
6809Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6810
6811@table @code
6812@item tfind start
6813Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6814@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6815
6816@item tfind none
6817Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6818
6819@item tfind end
6820Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6821
6822@item tfind
6823No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6824
6825@item tfind -
6826Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6827retracing earlier steps.
6828
6829@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6830Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6831proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6832argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6833for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6834
6835@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6836Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6837program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6838snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6839snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6840
6841@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6842Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6843addresses.
6844
6845@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6846Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6847@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6848
6849@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6850Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6851the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6852that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6853trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6854next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6855@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6856stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6857@end table
6858
6859The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6860designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6861instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6862snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6863trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6864simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6865snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6866@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6867The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6868for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6869no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6870(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6871no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6872tracepoint as the current one.
6873
6874In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6875these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6876scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6877you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6878registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6879
6880@smallexample
6881(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6882(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6883> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6884 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6885> tfind
6886> end
6887
6888Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6889Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6890Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6891Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6892Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6893Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6894Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6895Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6896Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6897Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6898Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6899@end smallexample
6900
6901Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6902the buffer:
6903
6904@smallexample
6905(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6906(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6907> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6908> tfind line
6909> end
6910
6911Frame 0, X = 1
6912Frame 7, X = 2
6913Frame 13, X = 255
6914@end smallexample
6915
6916@node tdump
6917@subsection @code{tdump}
6918@kindex tdump
6919@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6920@cindex tracepoint data, display
6921
6922This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6923the current trace snapshot.
6924
6925@smallexample
6926(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6927(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6928Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6929> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6930> end
6931
6932(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6933
6934(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6935#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6936at gdb_test.c:444
6937444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6938
6939(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6940Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6941d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6942d1 0x18 24
6943d2 0x80 128
6944d3 0x33 51
6945d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6946d5 0x22 34
6947d6 0xe0 224
6948d7 0x380035 3670069
6949a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6950a1 0x3000668 50333288
6951a2 0x100 256
6952a3 0x322000 3284992
6953a4 0x3000698 50333336
6954a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6955fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6956sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6957ps 0x0 0
6958pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6959fpcontrol 0x0 0
6960fpstatus 0x0 0
6961fpiaddr 0x0 0
6962p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6963p1 = (void *) 0x11
6964p2 = (void *) 0x22
6965p3 = (void *) 0x33
6966p4 = (void *) 0x44
6967p5 = (void *) 0x55
6968p6 = (void *) 0x66
6969gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6970
6971(@value{GDBP})
6972@end smallexample
6973
6974@node save-tracepoints
6975@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6976@kindex save-tracepoints
6977@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6978
6979This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6980their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6981suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6982tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6983Files}).
6984
6985@node Tracepoint Variables
6986@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6987@cindex tracepoint variables
6988@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6989
6990@table @code
6991@vindex $trace_frame
6992@item (int) $trace_frame
6993The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6994snapshot is selected.
6995
6996@vindex $tracepoint
6997@item (int) $tracepoint
6998The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6999
7000@vindex $trace_line
7001@item (int) $trace_line
7002The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7003
7004@vindex $trace_file
7005@item (char []) $trace_file
7006The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7007
7008@vindex $trace_func
7009@item (char []) $trace_func
7010The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7011@end table
7012
7013Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7014use @code{output} instead.
7015
7016Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7017stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7018data.
7019
7020@smallexample
7021(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7022
7023(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7024> output $trace_file
7025> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7026> tfind
7027> end
7028@end smallexample
7029
df0cd8c5
JB
7030@node Overlays
7031@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7032@cindex overlays
7033
7034If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7035memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7036problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7037use overlays.
7038
7039@menu
7040* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7041* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7042* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7043 mapped by asking the inferior.
7044* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7045@end menu
7046
7047@node How Overlays Work
7048@section How Overlays Work
7049@cindex mapped overlays
7050@cindex unmapped overlays
7051@cindex load address, overlay's
7052@cindex mapped address
7053@cindex overlay area
7054
7055Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7056kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7057other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7058management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7059adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7060
7061One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7062independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7063@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7064their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7065instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7066largest overlay as well.
7067
7068Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7069overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7070for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7071there.
7072
c928edc0
AC
7073@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7074@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7075@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7076
474c8240 7077@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7078@group
c928edc0
AC
7079 Data Instruction Larger
7080Address Space Address Space Address Space
7081+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7082| | | | | |
7083+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7084| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7085| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7086| and heap | | | | | |
7087+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7088| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7089+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7090 | | | | | |
7091 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7092 address | | | | | |
7093 | overlay | <-' | | |
7094 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7095 | | <---. | | load address
7096 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7097 | | | |
7098 +-----------+ | |
7099 +-----------+
7100 | |
7101 +-----------+
7102
7103 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7104@end group
474c8240 7105@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7106
c928edc0
AC
7107The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7108and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7109its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7110Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7111may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7112data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7113program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7114program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7115
7116An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7117@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7118instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7119in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7120is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7121the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7122called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7123
7124Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7125program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7126global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7127
7128@itemize @bullet
7129
7130@item
7131Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7132must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7133return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7134overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7135
7136@item
7137If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7138will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7139your program's performance.
7140
7141@item
7142The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7143overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7144mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7145and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7146You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7147addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7148ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7149
7150@item
7151The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7152to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7153instruction and data spaces.
7154
7155@end itemize
7156
7157The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7158improved in many ways:
7159
7160@itemize @bullet
7161
7162@item
7163If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7164hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7165contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7166This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7167area in the usual way.
7168
7169@item
7170If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7171overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7172
7173@item
7174You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7175general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7176code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7177return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7178the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7179must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7180different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7181
7182@end itemize
7183
7184
7185@node Overlay Commands
7186@section Overlay Commands
7187
7188To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7189correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7190virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7191mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7192@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7193variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7194
7195@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7196you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7197
7198@table @code
7199@item overlay off
7200@kindex overlay off
7201Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7202disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7203always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7204overlay support is disabled.
7205
7206@item overlay manual
7207@kindex overlay manual
7208@cindex manual overlay debugging
7209Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7210relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7211using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7212commands described below.
7213
7214@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7215@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7216@kindex overlay map-overlay
7217@cindex map an overlay
7218Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7219be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7220overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7221functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7222that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7223@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7224
7225@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7226@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7227@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7228@cindex unmap an overlay
7229Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7230must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7231When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7232overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7233
7234@item overlay auto
7235@kindex overlay auto
7236Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7237consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7238to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7239Overlay Debugging}.
7240
7241@item overlay load-target
7242@itemx overlay load
7243@kindex overlay load-target
7244@cindex reloading the overlay table
7245Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7246re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7247stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7248overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7249useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7250
7251@item overlay list-overlays
7252@itemx overlay list
7253@cindex listing mapped overlays
7254Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7255addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7256
7257@end table
7258
7259Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7260of the function the address falls in:
7261
474c8240 7262@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7263(gdb) print main
7264$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7265@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7266@noindent
7267When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7268unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7269asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7270unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7271
474c8240 7272@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7273(gdb) overlay list
7274No sections are mapped.
7275(gdb) print foo
7276$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7277@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7278@noindent
7279When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7280name normally:
7281
474c8240 7282@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7283(gdb) overlay list
7284Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7285 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7286(gdb) print foo
7287$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7288@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7289
7290When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7291address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7292overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7293@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7294code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7295
7296@itemize @bullet
7297@item
7298@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7299@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7300You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7301@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7302@item
7303@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7304unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7305overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7306you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7307breakpoints properly.
7308@end itemize
7309
7310
7311@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7312@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7313@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7314
7315@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7316are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7317inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7318@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7319looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7320current state of the overlays.
7321
7322Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7323@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7324
7325@table @asis
7326
7327@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7328This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7329
474c8240 7330@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7331struct
7332@{
7333 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7334 unsigned long vma;
7335
7336 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7337 unsigned long size;
7338
7339 /* The overlay's load address. */
7340 unsigned long lma;
7341
7342 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7343 zero otherwise. */
7344 unsigned long mapped;
7345@}
474c8240 7346@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7347
7348@item @code{_novlys}:
7349This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7350number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7351
7352@end table
7353
7354To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7355looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7356@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7357executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7358the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7359currently mapped.
7360
81d46470 7361In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7362@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7363will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7364calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7365will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7366are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7367in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7368overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7369are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7370
7371@node Overlay Sample Program
7372@section Overlay Sample Program
7373@cindex overlay example program
7374
7375When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7376at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7377addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7378Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7379since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7380architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7381portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7382
7383However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7384program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7385suite. The program consists of the following files from
7386@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7387
7388@table @file
7389@item overlays.c
7390The main program file.
7391@item ovlymgr.c
7392A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7393@item foo.c
7394@itemx bar.c
7395@itemx baz.c
7396@itemx grbx.c
7397Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7398@item d10v.ld
7399@itemx m32r.ld
7400Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7401and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7402@end table
7403
7404You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7405cross-compiler like this:
7406
474c8240 7407@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7408$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7409$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7410$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7411$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7412$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7413$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7414$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7415 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7416@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7417
7418The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7419you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7420target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7421
7422
6d2ebf8b 7423@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7424@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7425@cindex languages
7426
c906108c
SS
7427Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7428rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7429dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7430Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7431represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7432@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7433
7434@cindex working language
7435Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7436allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7437native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7438consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7439language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7440language}.
7441
7442@menu
7443* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7444* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7445* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7446* Support:: Supported languages
7447@end menu
7448
6d2ebf8b 7449@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7450@section Switching between source languages
7451
7452There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7453set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7454@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7455defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7456used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7457are printed, etc.
7458
7459In addition to the working language, every source file that
7460@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7461file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7462source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7463language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7464controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7465show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7466set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7467set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7468Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7469
7470This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7471as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7472another language. In that case, make the
7473program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7474@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7475program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7476
7477@menu
7478* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7479* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7480* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7481@end menu
7482
6d2ebf8b 7483@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7484@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7485
7486If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7487@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7488
7489@table @file
7490
7491@item .c
7492C source file
7493
7494@item .C
7495@itemx .cc
7496@itemx .cp
7497@itemx .cpp
7498@itemx .cxx
7499@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7500C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7501
7502@item .f
7503@itemx .F
7504Fortran source file
7505
c906108c
SS
7506@item .mod
7507Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7508
7509@item .s
7510@itemx .S
7511Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7512@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7513@end table
7514
7515In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7516extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7517
6d2ebf8b 7518@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7519@subsection Setting the working language
7520
7521If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7522expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7523your program.
7524
7525@kindex set language
7526If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7527command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7528a language, such as
c906108c 7529@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7530For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7531
c906108c
SS
7532Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7533language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7534to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7535source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7536languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7537source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7538command such as:
7539
474c8240 7540@smallexample
c906108c 7541print a = b + c
474c8240 7542@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7543
7544@noindent
7545might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7546@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7547printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7548@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7549
6d2ebf8b 7550@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7551@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7552
7553To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7554@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7555then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7556frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7557working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7558frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7559or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7560does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7561not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7562
7563This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7564entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7565written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7566a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7567case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7568
6d2ebf8b 7569@node Show
c906108c 7570@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7571
7572The following commands help you find out which language is the
7573working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7574
7575@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7576@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7577@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7578@table @code
7579@item show language
7580Display the current working language. This is the
7581language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7582build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7583
7584@item info frame
5d161b24 7585Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7586working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7587@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7588information listed here.
7589
7590@item info source
7591Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7592@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7593information listed here.
7594@end table
7595
7596In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7597not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7598with a language explicitly:
7599
7600@kindex set extension-language
7601@kindex info extensions
7602@table @code
7603@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7604Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7605the source language @var{language}.
7606
7607@item info extensions
7608List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7609@end table
7610
6d2ebf8b 7611@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7612@section Type and range checking
7613
7614@quotation
7615@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7616checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7617section documents the intended facilities.
7618@end quotation
7619@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7620
7621Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7622errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7623checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7624sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7625these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7626by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7627errors when your program is running.
7628
7629@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7630Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7631can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7632the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7633@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7634your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7635for the default settings of supported languages.
7636
7637@menu
7638* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7639* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7640@end menu
7641
7642@cindex type checking
7643@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7644@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7645@subsection An overview of type checking
7646
7647Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7648arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7649otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7650errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7651
7652@smallexample
76531 + 2 @result{} 3
7654@exdent but
7655@error{} 1 + 2.3
7656@end smallexample
7657
7658The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7659type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7660
5d161b24
DB
7661For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7662@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7663to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7664or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7665but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7666these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7667also issues a warning.
7668
5d161b24
DB
7669Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7670related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7671For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7672a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7673with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7674the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7675
7676Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7677instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7678operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7679represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7680operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7681details on specific languages.
7682
7683@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7684
d4f3574e 7685@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7686@kindex set check type
7687@kindex show check type
7688@table @code
7689@item set check type auto
7690Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7691@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7692each language.
7693
7694@item set check type on
7695@itemx set check type off
7696Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7697current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7698match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7699evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7700message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7701
7702@item set check type warn
7703Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7704evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7705be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7706numbers and structures.
7707
7708@item show type
5d161b24 7709Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7710is setting it automatically.
7711@end table
7712
7713@cindex range checking
7714@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7715@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7716@subsection An overview of range checking
7717
7718In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7719bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7720checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7721computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7722not exceed the bounds of the array.
7723
7724For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7725@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7726always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7727warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7728
7729A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7730array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7731of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7732error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7733result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7734the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7735
474c8240 7736@smallexample
c906108c 7737@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7738@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7739
7740This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7741specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7742Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7743
7744@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7745
d4f3574e 7746@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7747@kindex set check range
7748@kindex show check range
7749@table @code
7750@item set check range auto
7751Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7752@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7753each language.
7754
7755@item set check range on
7756@itemx set check range off
7757Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7758current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7759match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7760then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7761
7762@item set check range warn
7763Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7764but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7765expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7766memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7767systems).
7768
7769@item show range
7770Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7771being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7772@end table
c906108c 7773
6d2ebf8b 7774@node Support
c906108c 7775@section Supported languages
c906108c 7776
e632838e 7777@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7778@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7779Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7780language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7781and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7782,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7783language.
7784
7785The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7786supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7787tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7788@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7789formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7790books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7791language reference or tutorial.
7792
c906108c 7793@menu
b37052ae 7794* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7795* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7796@end menu
7797
6d2ebf8b 7798@node C
b37052ae 7799@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7800
b37052ae
EZ
7801@cindex C and C@t{++}
7802@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7803
b37052ae 7804Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7805to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7806together.
7807
41afff9a
EZ
7808@cindex C@t{++}
7809@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7810@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7811The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7812compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7813effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7814C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7815compiler (@code{aCC}).
7816
0179ffac
DC
7817For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7818format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7819format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7820command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7821@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7822CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
c906108c 7823
c906108c 7824@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7825* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7826* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7827* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7828* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7829* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7830* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7831* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7832@end menu
c906108c 7833
6d2ebf8b 7834@node C Operators
b37052ae 7835@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7836
b37052ae 7837@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7838
7839Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7840@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7841often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7842
b37052ae 7843For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7844
7845@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7846
c906108c 7847@item
c906108c 7848@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7849specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7850
7851@item
d4f3574e
SS
7852@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7853@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7854
7855@item
53a5351d 7856@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7857
7858@item
7859@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7860
c906108c
SS
7861@end itemize
7862
7863@noindent
7864The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7865in order of increasing precedence:
7866
7867@table @code
7868@item ,
7869The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7870are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7871expression being the last expression evaluated.
7872
7873@item =
7874Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7875assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7876
7877@item @var{op}=
7878Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7879and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7880@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7881@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7882@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7883
7884@item ?:
7885The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7886of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7887integral type.
7888
7889@item ||
7890Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7891
7892@item &&
7893Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7894
7895@item |
7896Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7897
7898@item ^
7899Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7900
7901@item &
7902Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7903
7904@item ==@r{, }!=
7905Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7906expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7907
7908@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7909Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7910Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7911and non-zero for true.
7912
7913@item <<@r{, }>>
7914left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7915
7916@item @@
7917The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7918
7919@item +@r{, }-
7920Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7921pointer types.
7922
7923@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7924Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7925defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7926integral types.
7927
7928@item ++@r{, }--
7929Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7930operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7931when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7932operation takes place.
7933
7934@item *
7935Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7936@code{++}.
7937
7938@item &
7939Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7940
b37052ae
EZ
7941For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7942allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7943(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7944where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7945stored.
c906108c
SS
7946
7947@item -
7948Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7949precedence as @code{++}.
7950
7951@item !
7952Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7953@code{++}.
7954
7955@item ~
7956Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7957@code{++}.
7958
7959
7960@item .@r{, }->
7961Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7962@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7963pointer based on the stored type information.
7964Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7965
c906108c
SS
7966@item .*@r{, }->*
7967Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7968
7969@item []
7970Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7971@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7972
7973@item ()
7974Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7975
c906108c 7976@item ::
b37052ae 7977C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7978and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7979
7980@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7981Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7982(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7983above.
c906108c
SS
7984@end table
7985
c906108c
SS
7986If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7987attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7988predefined meaning.
c906108c 7989
c906108c 7990@menu
5d161b24 7991* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7992@end menu
7993
6d2ebf8b 7994@node C Constants
b37052ae 7995@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7996
b37052ae 7997@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7998
b37052ae 7999@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 8000following ways:
c906108c
SS
8001
8002@itemize @bullet
8003@item
8004Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
8005specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8006by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
8007@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8008@code{long} value.
8009
8010@item
8011Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8012point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8013exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8014@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8015sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
8016A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8017@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8018the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8019a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8020constant.
c906108c
SS
8021
8022@item
8023Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8024integral equivalents.
8025
8026@item
8027Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8028(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 8029(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
8030be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8031the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8032of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8033@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8034@samp{\n} for newline.
8035
8036@item
96a2c332
SS
8037String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8038double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8039above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8040a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8041characters.
c906108c
SS
8042
8043@item
8044Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8045to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8046
8047@item
8048Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8049and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8050integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8051and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8052@end itemize
8053
c906108c 8054@menu
5d161b24
DB
8055* C plus plus expressions::
8056* C Defaults::
8057* C Checks::
c906108c 8058
5d161b24 8059* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8060@end menu
8061
6d2ebf8b 8062@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8063@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8064
8065@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8066@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8067
0179ffac
DC
8068@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8069@cindex C@t{++} compilers
8070@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8071@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
c906108c 8072@quotation
b37052ae 8073@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
0179ffac
DC
8074proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8075works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8076@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8077@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8078stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8079stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8080specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8081are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8082C@t{++} code.
c906108c 8083@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8084
8085@enumerate
8086
8087@cindex member functions
8088@item
8089Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8090
474c8240 8091@smallexample
c906108c 8092count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8093@end smallexample
c906108c 8094
41afff9a 8095@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8096@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8097@item
8098While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8099expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8100that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8101pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8102
c906108c 8103@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8104@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8105@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8106@item
8107You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8108call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8109perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8110calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8111in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8112default arguments.
8113
8114It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8115promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8116class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8117functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8118number of function arguments.
8119
8120Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8121@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8122,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8123
d4f3574e 8124You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8125explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8126@smallexample
8127p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8128@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8129
c906108c 8130The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8131see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8132
c906108c
SS
8133@cindex reference declarations
8134@item
b37052ae
EZ
8135@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8136them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8137dereferenced.
8138
8139In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8140reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8141avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8142The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8143you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8144
8145@item
b37052ae 8146@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8147expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8148one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8149necessary, for example in an expression like
8150@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8151resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8152debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8153@end enumerate
8154
b37052ae 8155In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8156calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8157objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8158invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8159
6d2ebf8b 8160@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8161@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8162
b37052ae 8163@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8164
c906108c
SS
8165If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8166both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8167C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8168selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8169
8170If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8171recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8172@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8173these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8174@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8175for further details.
8176
c906108c
SS
8177@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8178@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8179@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8180
6d2ebf8b 8181@node C Checks
b37052ae 8182@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8183
b37052ae 8184@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8185
b37052ae 8186By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8187is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8188considers two variables type equivalent if:
8189
8190@itemize @bullet
8191@item
8192The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8193enumerated tag.
8194
8195@item
8196The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8197declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8198
8199@ignore
8200@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8201@c FIXME--beers?
8202@item
8203The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8204declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8205compilers.)
8206@end ignore
8207@end itemize
8208
8209Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8210indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8211that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8212
6d2ebf8b 8213@node Debugging C
c906108c 8214@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8215
8216The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8217the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8218inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8219appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8220
8221The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8222with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8223,Expressions}.
8224
c906108c 8225@menu
5d161b24 8226* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8227@end menu
8228
6d2ebf8b 8229@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8230@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8231
b37052ae 8232@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8233
b37052ae
EZ
8234Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8235designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8236
8237@table @code
8238@cindex break in overloaded functions
8239@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8240When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8241@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8242you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8243
b37052ae 8244@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8245@item rbreak @var{regex}
8246Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8247breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8248classes.
8249@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8250
b37052ae 8251@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8252@item catch throw
8253@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8254Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8255Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8256
8257@cindex inheritance
8258@item ptype @var{typename}
8259Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8260@var{typename}.
8261@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8262
b37052ae 8263@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8264@item set print demangle
8265@itemx show print demangle
8266@itemx set print asm-demangle
8267@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8268Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8269displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8270@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8271
8272@item set print object
8273@itemx show print object
8274Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8275@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8276
8277@item set print vtbl
8278@itemx show print vtbl
8279Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8280@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8281(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8282ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8283
8284@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8285@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8286@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8287Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8288is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8289and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8290using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8291expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8292message.
8293
8294@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8295Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8296overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8297chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8298symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8299overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8300searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8301argument types.
c906108c
SS
8302
8303@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8304You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8305the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8306@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8307also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8308available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8309@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8310@end table
c906108c 8311
6d2ebf8b 8312@node Modula-2
c906108c 8313@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8314
d4f3574e 8315@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8316
8317The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8318output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8319developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8320attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8321to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8322table.
8323
8324@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8325@menu
8326* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8327* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8328* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8329* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8330* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8331* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8332* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8333* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8334@end menu
8335
6d2ebf8b 8336@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8337@subsubsection Operators
8338@cindex Modula-2 operators
8339
8340Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8341@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8342often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8343following definitions hold:
8344
8345@itemize @bullet
8346
8347@item
8348@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8349their subranges.
8350
8351@item
8352@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8353
8354@item
8355@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8356
8357@item
8358@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8359@var{type}}.
8360
8361@item
8362@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8363
8364@item
8365@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8366
8367@item
8368@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8369@end itemize
8370
8371@noindent
8372The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8373increasing precedence:
8374
8375@table @code
8376@item ,
8377Function argument or array index separator.
8378
8379@item :=
8380Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8381@var{value}.
8382
8383@item <@r{, }>
8384Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8385types.
8386
8387@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8388Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8389on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8390set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8391
8392@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8393Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8394Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8395available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8396comment character.
8397
8398@item IN
8399Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8400Same precedence as @code{<}.
8401
8402@item OR
8403Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8404
8405@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8406Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8407
8408@item @@
8409The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8410
8411@item +@r{, }-
8412Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8413and difference on set types.
8414
8415@item *
8416Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8417on set types.
8418
8419@item /
8420Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8421types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8422
8423@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8424Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8425precedence as @code{*}.
8426
8427@item -
8428Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8429
8430@item ^
8431Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8432
8433@item NOT
8434Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8435@code{^}.
8436
8437@item .
8438@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8439precedence as @code{^}.
8440
8441@item []
8442Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8443
8444@item ()
8445Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8446as @code{^}.
8447
8448@item ::@r{, }.
8449@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8450@end table
8451
8452@quotation
8453@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8454treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8455@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8456@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8457@end quotation
8458
cb51c4e0 8459
6d2ebf8b 8460@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8461@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8462@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8463
8464Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8465In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8466
8467@table @var
8468
8469@item a
8470represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8471
8472@item c
8473represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8474
8475@item i
8476represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8477
8478@item m
8479represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8480same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8481be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8482
8483@item n
8484represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8485
8486@item r
8487represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8488
8489@item t
8490represents a type.
8491
8492@item v
8493represents a variable.
8494
8495@item x
8496represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8497explanation of the function for details.
8498@end table
8499
8500All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8501
8502@table @code
8503@item ABS(@var{n})
8504Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8505
8506@item CAP(@var{c})
8507If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8508equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8509
8510@item CHR(@var{i})
8511Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8512
8513@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8514Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8515
8516@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8517Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8518new value.
8519
8520@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8521Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8522set.
8523
8524@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8525Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8526
8527@item HIGH(@var{a})
8528Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8529
8530@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8531Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8532
8533@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8534Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8535new value.
8536
8537@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8538Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8539there. Returns the new set.
8540
8541@item MAX(@var{t})
8542Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8543
8544@item MIN(@var{t})
8545Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8546
8547@item ODD(@var{i})
8548Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8549
8550@item ORD(@var{x})
8551Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8552value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8553@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8554integral, character and enumerated types.
8555
8556@item SIZE(@var{x})
8557Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8558
8559@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8560Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8561
8562@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8563Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8564@end table
8565
8566@quotation
8567@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8568@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8569an error.
8570@end quotation
8571
8572@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8573@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8574@subsubsection Constants
8575
8576@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8577ways:
8578
8579@itemize @bullet
8580
8581@item
8582Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8583expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8584rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8585trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8586
8587@item
8588Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8589decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8590then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8591@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8592digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8593digits.
8594
8595@item
8596Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8597like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8598also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8599followed by a @samp{C}.
8600
8601@item
8602String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8603pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8604Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8605Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8606sequences.
8607
8608@item
8609Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8610
8611@item
8612Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8613@code{FALSE}.
8614
8615@item
8616Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8617
8618@item
8619Set constants are not yet supported.
8620@end itemize
8621
6d2ebf8b 8622@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8623@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8624@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8625
8626If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8627both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8628Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8629selected the working language.
8630
8631If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8632code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8633working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8634the language automatically}, for further details.
8635
6d2ebf8b 8636@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8637@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8638@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8639
8640A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8641This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8642
8643@itemize @bullet
8644@item
8645Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8646integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8647debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8648pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8649through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8650returned a pointer.)
8651
8652@item
8653C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8654non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8655escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8656printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8657
8658@item
8659The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8660argument.
8661
8662@item
8663All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8664@end itemize
8665
6d2ebf8b 8666@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8667@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8668@cindex Modula-2 checks
8669
8670@quotation
8671@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8672range checking.
8673@end quotation
8674@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8675
8676@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8677
8678@itemize @bullet
8679@item
8680They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8681@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8682
8683@item
8684They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8685@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8686@end itemize
8687
8688As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8689whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8690
8691Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8692index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8693
6d2ebf8b 8694@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8695@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8696@cindex scope
41afff9a 8697@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8698@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8699@ifinfo
41afff9a 8700@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8701@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8702@end ifinfo
8703@iftex
41afff9a 8704@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8705@end iftex
8706
8707There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8708(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8709similar syntax:
8710
474c8240 8711@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8712
8713@var{module} . @var{id}
8714@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8715@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8716
8717@noindent
8718where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8719@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8720identifier within your program, except another module.
8721
8722Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8723specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8724found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8725enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8726
8727Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8728the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8729definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8730an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8731module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8732@var{module}.
8733
6d2ebf8b 8734@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8735@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8736
8737Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8738Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8739specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8740@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8741apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8742analogue in Modula-2.
8743
8744The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8745with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8746intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8747created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8748address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8749@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8750
8751@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8752In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8753interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8754
6d2ebf8b 8755@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8756@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8757
d4f3574e 8758The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8759symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8760program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8761does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8762program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8763(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8764file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8765
8766@cindex symbol names
8767@cindex names of symbols
8768@cindex quoting names
8769Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8770characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8771most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8772source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8773are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8774ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8775@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8776@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8777
474c8240 8778@smallexample
c906108c 8779p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8780@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8781
8782@noindent
8783looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8784
8785@table @code
8786@kindex info address
b37052ae 8787@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8788@item info address @var{symbol}
8789Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8790variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8791local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8792is always stored.
8793
8794Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8795at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8796the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8797
3d67e040 8798@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8799@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8800@item info symbol @var{addr}
8801Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8802If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8803nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8804
474c8240 8805@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8806(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8807_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8808@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8809
8810@noindent
8811This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8812it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8813
c906108c 8814@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8815@item whatis @var{expr}
8816Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8817actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8818assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8819@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8820
8821@item whatis
8822Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8823
8824@kindex ptype
8825@item ptype @var{typename}
8826Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8827the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8828@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8829@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8830
d4f3574e 8831@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8832@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8833Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8834differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8835of just the name of the type.
8836
8837For example, for this variable declaration:
8838
474c8240 8839@smallexample
c906108c 8840struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8841@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8842
8843@noindent
8844the two commands give this output:
8845
474c8240 8846@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8847@group
8848(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8849type = struct complex
8850(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8851type = struct complex @{
8852 double real;
8853 double imag;
8854@}
8855@end group
474c8240 8856@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8857
8858@noindent
8859As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8860the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8861
8862@kindex info types
8863@item info types @var{regexp}
8864@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8865Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8866(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8867complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8868@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8869names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8870information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8871
8872This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8873@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8874lists all source files where a type is defined.
8875
b37052ae
EZ
8876@kindex info scope
8877@cindex local variables
8878@item info scope @var{addr}
8879List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8880accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8881preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8882scope defined by that location. For example:
8883
8884@smallexample
8885(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8886Scope for command_line_handler:
8887Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8888Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8889Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8890Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8891Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8892Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8893Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8894@end smallexample
8895
f5c37c66
EZ
8896@noindent
8897This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8898during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8899collect}.
8900
c906108c
SS
8901@kindex info source
8902@item info source
919d772c
JB
8903Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8904the function containing the current point of execution:
8905@itemize @bullet
8906@item
8907the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8908@item
8909the directory it was compiled in,
8910@item
8911its length, in lines,
8912@item
8913which programming language it is written in,
8914@item
8915whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8916if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8917@item
8918whether the debugging information includes information about
8919preprocessor macros.
8920@end itemize
8921
c906108c
SS
8922
8923@kindex info sources
8924@item info sources
8925Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8926debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8927have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8928
8929@kindex info functions
8930@item info functions
8931Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8932
8933@item info functions @var{regexp}
8934Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8935whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8936Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8937include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8938start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8939that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8940@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8941
8942@kindex info variables
8943@item info variables
8944Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8945outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8946
8947@item info variables @var{regexp}
8948Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8949variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8950@var{regexp}.
8951
8952@ignore
8953This was never implemented.
8954@kindex info methods
8955@item info methods
8956@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8957The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8958methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8959specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8960C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8961from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8962@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8963which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8964@end ignore
8965
c906108c
SS
8966@cindex reloading symbols
8967Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8968be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8969in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8970running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8971@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8972
8973@table @code
8974@kindex set symbol-reloading
8975@item set symbol-reloading on
8976Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8977object file with a particular name is seen again.
8978
8979@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8980Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8981same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8982running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8983should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8984may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8985several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8986name.
c906108c
SS
8987
8988@kindex show symbol-reloading
8989@item show symbol-reloading
8990Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8991@end table
c906108c 8992
c906108c
SS
8993@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8994@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8995Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8996declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8997@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8998source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8999another source file. The default is on.
9000
9001A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9002the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9003
9004@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9005Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9006is printed as follows:
9007@smallexample
9008@{<no data fields>@}
9009@end smallexample
9010
9011@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9012@item show opaque-type-resolution
9013Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9014
9015@kindex maint print symbols
9016@cindex symbol dump
9017@kindex maint print psymbols
9018@cindex partial symbol dump
9019@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9020@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9021@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9022Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9023These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9024symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9025symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9026collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9027only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9028command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9029use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9030symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9031files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9032@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9033required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9034@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9035@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9036@end table
9037
6d2ebf8b 9038@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9039@chapter Altering Execution
9040
9041Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9042find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9043correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9044experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9045program.
9046
9047For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9048locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9049address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9050
9051@menu
9052* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9053* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9054* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9055* Returning:: Returning from a function
9056* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9057* Patching:: Patching your program
9058@end menu
9059
6d2ebf8b 9060@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9061@section Assignment to variables
9062
9063@cindex assignment
9064@cindex setting variables
9065To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9066@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9067
474c8240 9068@smallexample
c906108c 9069print x=4
474c8240 9070@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9071
9072@noindent
9073stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9074value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9075@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9076information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9077
9078@kindex set variable
9079@cindex variables, setting
9080If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9081@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9082really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9083not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9084,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9085
c906108c
SS
9086If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9087appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9088variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9089to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9090program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9091a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9092command @code{set width}:
9093
474c8240 9094@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9095(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9096type = double
9097(@value{GDBP}) p width
9098$4 = 13
9099(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9100Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9101@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9102
9103@noindent
9104The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9105order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9106
474c8240 9107@smallexample
c906108c 9108(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9109@end smallexample
53a5351d 9110
c906108c
SS
9111Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9112with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9113@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9114your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9115to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9116the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9117
474c8240 9118@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9119@group
9120(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9121type = double
9122(@value{GDBP}) p g
9123$1 = 1
9124(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9125(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9126$2 = 1
9127(@value{GDBP}) r
9128The program being debugged has been started already.
9129Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9130Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9131"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9132 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9133(@value{GDBP}) show g
9134The current BFD target is "=4".
9135@end group
474c8240 9136@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9137
9138@noindent
9139The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9140@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9141@code{g}, use
9142
474c8240 9143@smallexample
c906108c 9144(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9145@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9146
9147@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9148freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9149and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9150same length or shorter.
9151@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9152@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9153
9154To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9155construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9156(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9157to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9158and representation in memory), and
9159
474c8240 9160@smallexample
c906108c 9161set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9162@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9163
9164@noindent
9165stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9166
6d2ebf8b 9167@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9168@section Continuing at a different address
9169
9170Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9171it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9172an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9173
9174@table @code
9175@kindex jump
9176@item jump @var{linespec}
9177Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9178immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9179source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9180@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9181in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9182breakpoints}.
9183
9184The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9185the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9186register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9187a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9188be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9189of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9190confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9191executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9192well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9193
9194@item jump *@var{address}
9195Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9196@end table
9197
c906108c 9198@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9199On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9200command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9201difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9202changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9203example,
c906108c 9204
474c8240 9205@smallexample
c906108c 9206set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9207@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9208
9209@noindent
9210makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9211address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9212@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9213
9214The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9215up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9216that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9217detail.
9218
c906108c 9219@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9220@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9221@section Giving your program a signal
9222
9223@table @code
9224@kindex signal
9225@item signal @var{signal}
9226Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9227signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9228signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9229SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9230
9231Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9232giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9233a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9234@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9235signal.
9236
9237@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9238after executing the command.
9239@end table
9240@c @end group
9241
9242Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9243@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9244causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9245the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9246passes the signal directly to your program.
9247
c906108c 9248
6d2ebf8b 9249@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9250@section Returning from a function
9251
9252@table @code
9253@cindex returning from a function
9254@kindex return
9255@item return
9256@itemx return @var{expression}
9257You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9258command. If you give an
9259@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9260value.
9261@end table
9262
9263When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9264(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9265discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9266be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9267
9268This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9269frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9270innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9271specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9272of functions.
9273
9274The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9275program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9276returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9277and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9278selected stack frame returns naturally.
9279
6d2ebf8b 9280@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9281@section Calling program functions
9282
9283@cindex calling functions
9284@kindex call
9285@table @code
9286@item call @var{expr}
9287Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9288returned values.
9289@end table
9290
9291You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9292execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9293with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9294is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9295
6d2ebf8b 9296@node Patching
c906108c 9297@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9298
c906108c
SS
9299@cindex patching binaries
9300@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9301@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9302
7a292a7a
SS
9303By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9304executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9305alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9306patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9307
9308If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9309explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9310want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9311repairs.
9312
9313@table @code
9314@kindex set write
9315@item set write on
9316@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9317If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9318core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9319off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9320
9321If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9322@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9323write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9324
9325@item show write
9326@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9327Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9328as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9329@end table
9330
6d2ebf8b 9331@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9332@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9333
7a292a7a
SS
9334@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9335both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9336program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9337@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9338
9339@menu
9340* Files:: Commands to specify files
5b5d99cf 9341* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
c906108c
SS
9342* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9343@end menu
9344
6d2ebf8b 9345@node Files
c906108c 9346@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9347
7a292a7a 9348@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9349@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9350
9351You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9352way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9353@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9354Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9355
9356Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9357@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9358a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9359to specify new files are useful.
9360
9361@table @code
9362@cindex executable file
9363@kindex file
9364@item file @var{filename}
9365Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9366symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9367executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9368directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9369@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9370directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9371to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9372and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9373
6d2ebf8b 9374On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9375@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9376@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9377@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9378descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9379(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9380@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9381for more information.
c906108c
SS
9382
9383@item file
9384@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9385has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9386
9387@kindex exec-file
9388@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9389Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9390in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9391if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9392discard information on the executable file.
9393
9394@kindex symbol-file
9395@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9396Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9397searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9398table and program to run from the same file.
9399
9400@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9401program's symbol table.
9402
5d161b24 9403The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9404of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9405auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9406the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9407the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9408
9409@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9410executing it once.
9411
9412When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9413understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9414generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9415other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9416Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9417using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9418optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9419
9420For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9421using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9422symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9423quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9424details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9425
9426The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9427start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9428occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9429file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9430pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9431warnings and messages}.)
9432
c906108c
SS
9433We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9434symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9435symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9436still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9437in stabs format.
9438
9439@kindex readnow
9440@cindex reading symbols immediately
9441@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9442@kindex mapped
9443@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9444@cindex saving symbol table
9445@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9446@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9447You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9448tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9449load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9450entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9451
c906108c
SS
9452If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9453@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9454cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9455file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9456from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9457than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9458program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9459starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9460
9461You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9462file has all the symbol information for your program.
9463
9464The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9465@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9466than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9467it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9468needed.
9469
9470The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9471@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9472symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9473
9474@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9475@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9476@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9477@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9478@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9479@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9480@c files.
9481
9482@kindex core
9483@kindex core-file
9484@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9485Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9486of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9487address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9488executable file itself for other parts.
9489
9490@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9491to be used.
9492
9493Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9494under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9495wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9496the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9497(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9498
c906108c
SS
9499@kindex add-symbol-file
9500@cindex dynamic linking
9501@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9502@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9503@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9504The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9505information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9506when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9507into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9508address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9509this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9510of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9511section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9512@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9513
9514The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9515originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9516@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9517thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9518instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9519
17d9d558
JB
9520@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9521@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9522@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9523@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9524@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9525Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9526executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9527relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9528information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9529
9530@itemize @bullet
9531@item
9532the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9533that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9534@item
9535every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9536been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9537@item
9538you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9539provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9540@end itemize
9541
9542@noindent
9543Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9544relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9545typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9546important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9547procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9548assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9549general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9550relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9551as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9552way.
9553
c906108c
SS
9554@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9555
9556You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9557the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9558table information for @var{filename}.
9559
9560@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9561@item add-shared-symbol-file
9562The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9563operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9564shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9565@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9566
c906108c
SS
9567@kindex section
9568@item section
5d161b24
DB
9569The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9570the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9571section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9572specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9573separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9574the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9575
9576@kindex info files
9577@kindex info target
9578@item info files
9579@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9580@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9581current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9582including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9583use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9584command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9585current ones.
9586
fe95c787
MS
9587@kindex maint info sections
9588@item maint info sections
9589Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9590is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9591displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9592offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9593@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9594may be arbitrarily combined):
9595
9596@table @code
9597@item ALLOBJ
9598Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9599@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9600Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9601@item @var{section-flags}
9602Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9603The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9604@table @code
9605@item ALLOC
9606Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9607Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9608@item LOAD
9609Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9610Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9611@item RELOC
9612Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9613@item READONLY
9614Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9615@item CODE
9616Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9617@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9618Section contains data only (no executable code).
9619@item ROM
9620Section will reside in ROM.
9621@item CONSTRUCTOR
9622Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9623@item HAS_CONTENTS
9624Section is not empty.
9625@item NEVER_LOAD
9626An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9627@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9628A notification to the linker that the section contains
9629COFF shared library information.
9630@item IS_COMMON
9631Section contains common symbols.
9632@end table
9633@end table
6763aef9
MS
9634@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9635@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9636Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9637really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9638In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9639out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9640For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9641enhancement to debugging performance.
9642
9643The default is off.
9644
9645@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9646Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9647the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9648and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9649@end table
9650
9651All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9652as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9653name and remembers it that way.
9654
c906108c 9655@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9656@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9657libraries.
53a5351d 9658
c906108c
SS
9659@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9660when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9661(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9662references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9663debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9664
9665On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9666automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9667
c906108c
SS
9668@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9669@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9670@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9671
b7209cb4
FF
9672There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9673symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9674particularly large or there are many of them.
9675
9676To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9677commands:
9678
9679@table @code
9680@kindex set auto-solib-add
9681@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9682If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9683will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9684attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9685informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9686is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9687@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9688
9689@kindex show auto-solib-add
9690@item show auto-solib-add
9691Display the current autoloading mode.
9692@end table
9693
9694To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9695command:
9696
c906108c
SS
9697@table @code
9698@kindex info sharedlibrary
9699@kindex info share
9700@item info share
9701@itemx info sharedlibrary
9702Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9703
9704@kindex sharedlibrary
9705@kindex share
9706@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9707@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9708Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9709Unix regular expression.
9710As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9711required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9712@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9713loaded.
9714@end table
9715
b7209cb4
FF
9716On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9717autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9718reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9719by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9720up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9721wish.
c906108c
SS
9722
9723Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9724loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9725@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9726automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9727
9728To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9729
9730@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9731@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9732@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9733Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9734If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9735symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9736size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9737Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9738@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9739Mb).
c906108c 9740
b7209cb4
FF
9741@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9742@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9743Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9744@end table
c906108c 9745
f5ebfba0
DJ
9746Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9747configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9748host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9749copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9750not.
9751
9752You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9753load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9754@value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9755libraries.
9756
9757@table @code
9758@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9759@item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9760If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9761absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9762paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9763@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9764out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9765@file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9766
9767You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9768configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9769
9770@kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9771@item show solib-absolute-prefix
9772Display the current shared library prefix.
9773
9774@kindex set solib-search-path
9775@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9776If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9777to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9778@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9779the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9780@samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9781set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9782@value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9783
9784@kindex show solib-search-path
9785@item show solib-search-path
9786Display the current shared library search path.
9787@end table
9788
5b5d99cf
JB
9789
9790@node Separate Debug Files
9791@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
9792@cindex separate debugging information files
9793@cindex debugging information in separate files
9794@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
9795@cindex debugging information directory, global
9796@cindex global debugging information directory
9797
9798@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
9799file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
9800@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
9801Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
9802than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
9803information for their executables in separate files, which users can
9804install only when they need to debug a problem.
9805
9806If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
9807separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
9808the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
9809components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
9810debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
9811containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
9812debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
9813will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
9814places:
9815
9816@itemize @bullet
9817@item
9818the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
9819for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
9820@item
9821a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
9822file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
9823@item
9824a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
9825executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
9826@file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
9827@var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
9828@var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
9829@end itemize
9830@noindent
9831@value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
9832information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
9833reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
9834
9835So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
9836which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
9837debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
9838for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
9839@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
9840@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
9841
9842You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
9843name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
9844
9845@table @code
9846
9847@kindex set debug-file-directory
9848@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
9849Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9850information files to @var{directory}.
9851
9852@kindex show debug-file-directory
9853@item show debug-file-directory
9854Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9855information files.
9856
9857@end table
9858
9859@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
9860@cindex debug links
9861A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
9862@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
9863
9864@itemize
9865@item
9866A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
9867a zero byte,
9868@item
9869zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
9870boundary within the section, and
9871@item
9872a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
9873executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
9874information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
9875zero as the @var{crc} argument.
9876@end itemize
9877
9878Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
9879contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
9880described above.
9881
9882The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
9883executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
9884debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
9885should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
9886but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
9887in an ordinary executable.
9888
9889As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
9890separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
9891Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
9892contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
9893@kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
9894the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
9895@file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
9896
9897Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
9898polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
9899describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
9900complete code for a function that computes it:
9901
9902@kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
9903@smallexample
9904unsigned long
9905gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
9906 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
9907@{
9908 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
9909 @{
9910 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
9911 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
9912 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
9913 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
9914 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
9915 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
9916 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
9917 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
9918 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
9919 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
9920 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
9921 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
9922 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
9923 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
9924 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
9925 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
9926 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
9927 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
9928 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
9929 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
9930 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
9931 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
9932 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
9933 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
9934 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
9935 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
9936 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
9937 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
9938 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
9939 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
9940 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
9941 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
9942 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
9943 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
9944 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
9945 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
9946 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
9947 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
9948 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
9949 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
9950 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
9951 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
9952 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
9953 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
9954 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
9955 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
9956 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
9957 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
9958 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
9959 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
9960 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
9961 0x2d02ef8d
9962 @};
9963 unsigned char *end;
9964
9965 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
9966 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
9967 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
9968 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;;
9969@}
9970@end smallexample
9971
9972
6d2ebf8b 9973@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9974@section Errors reading symbol files
9975
9976While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9977such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9978output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9979they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9980debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9981about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9982only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9983times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9984to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9985complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9986messages}).
9987
9988The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9989
9990@table @code
9991@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9992
9993The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9994(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9995error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9996in its outer scope blocks.
9997
9998@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9999the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10000may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10001function.
10002
10003@item block at @var{address} out of order
10004
10005The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10006order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10007do so.
10008
10009@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10010locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10011can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10012@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10013messages}.)
10014
10015@item bad block start address patched
10016
10017The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10018smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10019to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10020
10021@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10022starting on the previous source line.
10023
10024@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10025
10026@cindex foo
10027Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10028larger than the size of the string table.
10029
10030@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10031name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10032with this name.
10033
10034@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10035
7a292a7a
SS
10036The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10037not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 10038uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 10039
7a292a7a
SS
10040@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10041This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 10042are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
10043debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10044on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10045and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
10046
10047@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 10048
7a292a7a 10049@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 10050
7a292a7a 10051@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 10052The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
10053information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10054it.
c906108c
SS
10055
10056@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10057
10058@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 10059
c906108c
SS
10060@end table
10061
6d2ebf8b 10062@node Targets
c906108c 10063@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 10064
c906108c
SS
10065@cindex debugging target
10066@kindex target
10067
10068A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
10069
10070Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10071in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10072you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
10073flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10074host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
10075realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10076command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10077(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
10078
10079@menu
10080* Active Targets:: Active targets
10081* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
10082* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10083* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 10084* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
10085
10086@end menu
10087
6d2ebf8b 10088@node Active Targets
c906108c 10089@section Active targets
7a292a7a 10090
c906108c
SS
10091@cindex stacking targets
10092@cindex active targets
10093@cindex multiple targets
10094
c906108c 10095There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
10096executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10097active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10098start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10099a core file.
c906108c
SS
10100
10101For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10102@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10103well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10104@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10105first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10106requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10107are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10108read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10109executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10110
10111When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10112target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10113commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10114an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10115process target is active.
c906108c 10116
7a292a7a
SS
10117Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10118core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10119files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10120the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10121process}).
c906108c 10122
6d2ebf8b 10123@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10124@section Commands for managing targets
10125
10126@table @code
10127@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10128Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10129process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10130facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10131protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10132
10133Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10134typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10135with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10136
10137The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10138after executing the command.
10139
10140@kindex help target
10141@item help target
10142Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10143currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10144(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10145
10146@item help target @var{name}
10147Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10148select it.
10149
10150@kindex set gnutarget
10151@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10152@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10153knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10154a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10155with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10156with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10157
d4f3574e 10158@quotation
c906108c
SS
10159@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10160you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10161@end quotation
c906108c 10162
d4f3574e
SS
10163@noindent
10164@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10165
5d161b24 10166@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10167@item show gnutarget
10168Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10169@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10170@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10171and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10172@end table
10173
c906108c
SS
10174Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10175configuration):
c906108c
SS
10176
10177@table @code
10178@kindex target exec
10179@item target exec @var{program}
10180An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10181@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10182
c906108c
SS
10183@kindex target core
10184@item target core @var{filename}
10185A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10186@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10187
10188@kindex target remote
10189@item target remote @var{dev}
10190Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10191specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10192@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10193supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10194some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10195it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10196
c906108c
SS
10197@kindex target sim
10198@item target sim
2df3850c 10199Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10200In general,
474c8240 10201@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10202 target sim
10203 load
10204 run
474c8240 10205@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10206@noindent
104c1213 10207works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10208drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10209provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10210see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10211Processors}.
10212
c906108c
SS
10213@end table
10214
104c1213 10215Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10216
10217@table @code
10218
c906108c
SS
10219@kindex target nrom
10220@item target nrom @var{dev}
10221NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10222
c906108c
SS
10223@end table
10224
5d161b24 10225Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10226your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10227
10228Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10229once you've successfully established a connection.
10230
10231@table @code
10232
10233@kindex load @var{filename}
10234@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10235Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10236@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10237is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10238on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10239@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10240the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10241
10242If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10243execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10244target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10245
10246The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10247For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10248link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10249specifies a fixed address.
10250@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10251
c906108c
SS
10252@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10253@end table
10254
6d2ebf8b 10255@node Byte Order
c906108c 10256@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10257
c906108c
SS
10258@cindex choosing target byte order
10259@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10260
10261Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10262offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10263orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10264designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10265which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10266@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10267
10268@table @code
10269@kindex set endian big
10270@item set endian big
10271Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10272
10273@kindex set endian little
10274@item set endian little
10275Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10276
10277@kindex set endian auto
10278@item set endian auto
10279Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10280executable.
10281
10282@item show endian
10283Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10284
10285@end table
10286
10287Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10288data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10289target system.
10290
6d2ebf8b 10291@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10292@section Remote debugging
10293@cindex remote debugging
10294
10295If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10296@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10297For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10298or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10299powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10300
10301Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10302to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10303@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10304but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10305write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10306communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10307
10308Other remote targets may be available in your
10309configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10310
6f05cf9f
AC
10311@node KOD
10312@section Kernel Object Display
10313
10314@cindex kernel object display
10315@cindex kernel object
10316@cindex KOD
10317
10318Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10319@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10320and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10321mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10322displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10323
10324Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10325@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10326
474c8240 10327@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10328(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10329@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10330
10331If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10332about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10333which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10334after the operating system:
c906108c 10335
474c8240 10336@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10337(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10338List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10339Object Description
10340any Any and all objects
474c8240 10341@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10342
10343Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10344by the kernel.
10345
10346There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10347is supported other than to try it.
10348
10349
10350@node Remote Debugging
10351@chapter Debugging remote programs
10352
6b2f586d
AC
10353@menu
10354* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10355* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
501eef12 10356* Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
6b2f586d 10357* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10358@end menu
10359
6f05cf9f
AC
10360@node Server
10361@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10362
10363@kindex gdbserver
10364@cindex remote connection without stubs
10365@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10366allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10367@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10368
10369@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10370because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10371that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10372@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10373@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10374because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10375also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10376started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10377Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10378the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10379do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10380by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10381choice for debugging.
10382
10383@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10384or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10385protocol.
10386
10387@table @emph
10388@item On the target machine,
10389you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10390@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10391strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10392system does all the symbol handling.
10393
10394To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10395the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10396syntax is:
10397
10398@smallexample
10399target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10400@end smallexample
10401
10402@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10403hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10404@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10405@file{/dev/com1}:
10406
10407@smallexample
10408target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10409@end smallexample
10410
10411@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10412with it.
10413
10414To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10415
10416@smallexample
10417target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10418@end smallexample
10419
10420The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10421specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10422TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10423expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10424(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10425you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10426TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10427reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10428conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10429and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10430@code{target remote} command.
10431
56460a61
DJ
10432On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10433This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10434
10435@smallexample
10436target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10437@end smallexample
10438
10439@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10440to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10441
6f05cf9f
AC
10442@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10443you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10444symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10445using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10446(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10447running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10448remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10449is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10450@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10451@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10452
10453@smallexample
10454(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10455@end smallexample
10456
10457@noindent
10458communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10459
10460@smallexample
10461(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10462@end smallexample
10463
10464@noindent
10465communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10466For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10467the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10468text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10469@samp{Connection refused}.
10470@end table
10471
10472@node NetWare
10473@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10474
10475@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10476@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10477allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10478@code{target remote}.
10479
10480@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10481using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10482
10483@table @emph
10484@item On the target machine,
10485you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10486@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10487can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10488host system does all the symbol handling.
10489
10490To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10491@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10492program. The syntax is:
10493
10494@smallexample
10495load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10496 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10497@end smallexample
10498
10499@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10500the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10501to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10502
10503For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10504communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10505using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10506
10507@smallexample
10508load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10509@end smallexample
10510
10511@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10512you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10513symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10514using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10515(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10516running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10517remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10518argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10519@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10520
10521@smallexample
10522(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10523@end smallexample
10524
10525@noindent
10526communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10527@end table
10528
501eef12
AC
10529@node Remote configuration
10530@section Remote configuration
10531
10532The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
10533programs:
10534
10535@table @code
10536@kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
10537@kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
10538@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
10539@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
10540@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
10541@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
10542Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
10543watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
10544@end table
10545
6f05cf9f
AC
10546@node remote stub
10547@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10548
8e04817f
AC
10549@cindex debugging stub, example
10550@cindex remote stub, example
10551@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10552The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10553communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10554@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10555these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10556implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10557with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10558organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10559
104c1213
JM
10560@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10561To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10562@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10563prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10564program, you need:
c906108c 10565
104c1213
JM
10566@enumerate
10567@item
10568A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10569have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10570your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10571
5d161b24 10572@item
d4f3574e 10573A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10574subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10575
104c1213
JM
10576@item
10577A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10578download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10579manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10580documentation.
10581@end enumerate
96baa820 10582
104c1213
JM
10583The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10584communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10585machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10586
104c1213
JM
10587@table @emph
10588@item On the host,
10589@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10590else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10591(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10592
10593@item On the target,
10594you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10595implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10596subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10597
10598On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10599@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10600@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10601@end table
96baa820 10602
104c1213
JM
10603The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10604machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10605@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10606
104c1213
JM
10607@cindex remote serial stub list
10608These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10609
104c1213
JM
10610@table @code
10611
10612@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10613@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10614@cindex Intel
10615@cindex i386
10616For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10617
10618@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10619@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10620@cindex Motorola 680x0
10621@cindex m680x0
10622For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10623
10624@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10625@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10626@cindex Hitachi
10627@cindex SH
10628For Hitachi SH architectures.
10629
10630@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10631@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10632@cindex Sparc
10633For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10634
10635@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10636@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10637@cindex Fujitsu
10638@cindex SparcLite
10639For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10640
10641@end table
10642
10643The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10644recently added stubs.
10645
10646@menu
10647* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10648* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10649* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10650@end menu
10651
6d2ebf8b 10652@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10653@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10654
10655@cindex remote serial stub
10656The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10657subroutines:
10658
10659@table @code
10660@item set_debug_traps
10661@kindex set_debug_traps
10662@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10663This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10664program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10665beginning of your program.
10666
10667@item handle_exception
10668@kindex handle_exception
10669@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10670This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10671explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10672run when a trap is triggered.
10673
10674@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10675execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10676with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10677protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10678representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10679information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10680retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10681execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10682@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10683machine.
104c1213
JM
10684
10685@item breakpoint
10686@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10687Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10688breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10689way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10690machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10691pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10692@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10693simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10694again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10695your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10696@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10697
10698Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10699to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10700start of your debugging session.
10701@end table
10702
6d2ebf8b 10703@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10704@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10705
10706@cindex remote stub, support routines
10707The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10708chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10709debugging target machine.
10710
10711First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10712serial port.
10713
10714@table @code
10715@item int getDebugChar()
10716@kindex getDebugChar
10717Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10718It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10719different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10720
10721@item void putDebugChar(int)
10722@kindex putDebugChar
10723Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10724It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10725different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10726@end table
10727
10728@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10729@cindex interrupting remote targets
10730If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10731running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10732for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10733character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10734remote system to stop.
10735
10736Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10737probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10738is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10739@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10740
10741Other routines you need to supply are:
10742
10743@table @code
10744@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10745@kindex exceptionHandler
10746Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10747handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10748way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10749are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10750containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10751@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10752its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10753might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10754exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10755@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10756and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10757you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10758should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10759
10760For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10761gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10762should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10763@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10764help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10765
10766@item void flush_i_cache()
10767@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10768On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10769instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10770instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10771
10772On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10773function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10774@end table
10775
10776@noindent
10777You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10778
10779@table @code
10780@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10781@kindex memset
10782This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10783memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10784@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10785either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10786@end table
10787
10788If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10789library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10790but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10791subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10792
10793
6d2ebf8b 10794@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10795@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10796
10797@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10798In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10799steps.
10800
10801@enumerate
10802@item
6d2ebf8b 10803Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10804(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10805@display
10806@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10807@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10808@end display
10809
10810@item
10811Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10812
474c8240 10813@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10814set_debug_traps();
10815breakpoint();
474c8240 10816@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10817
10818@item
10819For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10820@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10821
474c8240 10822@smallexample
104c1213 10823void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10824@end smallexample
104c1213 10825
d4f3574e 10826@noindent
104c1213 10827but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10828function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10829@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10830error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10831one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10832
10833@item
10834Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10835your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10836
10837@item
10838Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10839the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10840
10841@item
10842@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10843@c document that. FIXME.
10844Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10845whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10846
10847@item
10848To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10849as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10850This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10851of its pure text.
10852
d4f3574e 10853@item
104c1213 10854@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10855Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10856Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10857machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10858TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10859to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10860device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10861
474c8240 10862@smallexample
104c1213 10863target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10864@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10865
10866@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10867To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10868@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10869For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10870terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10871
474c8240 10872@smallexample
104c1213 10873target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10874@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10875
10876If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10877your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10878the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10879to port 1234 on your local machine:
10880
474c8240 10881@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10882target remote :1234
474c8240 10883@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10884@noindent
10885
10886Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10887
10888@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10889To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10890@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10891on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10892
10893@smallexample
10894target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10895@end smallexample
10896
10897When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10898that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10899busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10900session.
10901
104c1213
JM
10902@end enumerate
10903
10904Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10905step and continue the remote program.
10906
10907To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10908command.
10909
10910@cindex interrupting remote programs
10911@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10912Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10913interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10914program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10915and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10916interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10917
474c8240 10918@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10919Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10920Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10921@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10922
10923If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10924(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10925remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10926goes back to waiting.
10927
104c1213 10928
8e04817f
AC
10929@node Configurations
10930@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10931
8e04817f
AC
10932While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10933cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10934describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10935
8e04817f
AC
10936There are three major categories of configurations: native
10937configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10938operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10939different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10940are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10941
8e04817f
AC
10942@menu
10943* Native::
10944* Embedded OS::
10945* Embedded Processors::
10946* Architectures::
10947@end menu
104c1213 10948
8e04817f
AC
10949@node Native
10950@section Native
104c1213 10951
8e04817f
AC
10952This section describes details specific to particular native
10953configurations.
6cf7e474 10954
8e04817f
AC
10955@menu
10956* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10957* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10958* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10959* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10960@end menu
6cf7e474 10961
8e04817f
AC
10962@node HP-UX
10963@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10964
8e04817f
AC
10965On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10966begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10967name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10968
8e04817f
AC
10969@node SVR4 Process Information
10970@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10971
8e04817f
AC
10972@kindex /proc
10973@cindex process image
104c1213 10974
8e04817f
AC
10975Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10976used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10977subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10978this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10979several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10980@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10981@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 10982and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 10983
8e04817f
AC
10984@table @code
10985@kindex info proc
10986@item info proc
10987Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10988
8e04817f
AC
10989@kindex info proc mappings
10990@item info proc mappings
10991Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10992on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10993@ignore
10994@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10995@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10996@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10997@kindex info proc times
10998@item info proc times
10999Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11000its children.
6cf7e474 11001
8e04817f
AC
11002@kindex info proc id
11003@item info proc id
11004Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11005the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 11006
8e04817f
AC
11007@kindex info proc status
11008@item info proc status
11009General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11010stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11011received.
d4f3574e 11012
8e04817f
AC
11013@item info proc all
11014Show all the above information about the process.
11015@end ignore
11016@end table
104c1213 11017
8e04817f
AC
11018@node DJGPP Native
11019@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11020@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11021@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11022@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 11023
8e04817f
AC
11024@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11025MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11026that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11027top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 11028
8e04817f
AC
11029@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11030defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11031subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 11032
8e04817f
AC
11033@table @code
11034@kindex info dos
11035@item info dos
11036This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11037information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 11038
8e04817f
AC
11039@kindex sysinfo
11040@cindex MS-DOS system info
11041@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11042@item info dos sysinfo
11043This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11044platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11045DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 11046
8e04817f
AC
11047@cindex GDT
11048@cindex LDT
11049@cindex IDT
11050@cindex segment descriptor tables
11051@cindex descriptor tables display
11052@item info dos gdt
11053@itemx info dos ldt
11054@itemx info dos idt
11055These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11056and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11057tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11058that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11059descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11060descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11061rights.
104c1213 11062
8e04817f
AC
11063A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11064segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11065allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11066conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11067additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 11068
8e04817f
AC
11069@cindex garbled pointers
11070These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11071Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11072displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11073display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11074example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11075debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 11076
8e04817f
AC
11077@smallexample
11078@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11079@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11080@end smallexample
104c1213 11081
8e04817f
AC
11082@noindent
11083This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11084the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 11085
8e04817f
AC
11086@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11087@item info dos pde
11088@itemx info dos pte
11089These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11090Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11091data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11092into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11093page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11094may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11095Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11096that is currently in use.
104c1213 11097
8e04817f
AC
11098Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11099Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11100the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11101@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11102Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11103means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11104the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 11105
8e04817f
AC
11106@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11107These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11108Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11109controller.
104c1213 11110
8e04817f 11111These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 11112
8e04817f
AC
11113@cindex physical address from linear address
11114@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11115This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11116address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11117appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11118accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11119example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11120the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11121
8e04817f
AC
11122@smallexample
11123@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11124@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11125@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11126@end smallexample
104c1213 11127
8e04817f
AC
11128@noindent
11129This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11130whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11131attributes of that page.
104c1213 11132
8e04817f
AC
11133Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11134since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11135address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11136be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11137declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11138@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11139
8e04817f
AC
11140Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11141transfer buffer:
104c1213 11142
8e04817f
AC
11143@smallexample
11144@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11145@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11146@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11147@end smallexample
104c1213 11148
8e04817f
AC
11149@noindent
11150(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
111513rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11152this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11153mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11154
8e04817f
AC
11155This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11156@end table
104c1213 11157
78c47bea
PM
11158@node Cygwin Native
11159@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11160@cindex MS Windows debugging
11161@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11162@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11163
be448670
CF
11164@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11165DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11166additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11167subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11168that have no debugging symbols.
11169
78c47bea
PM
11170
11171@table @code
11172@kindex info w32
11173@item info w32
11174This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11175information about the target system and important OS structures.
11176
11177@item info w32 selector
11178This command displays information returned by
11179the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11180It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11181a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11182Without argument, this command displays information
11183about the the six segment registers.
11184
11185@kindex info dll
11186@item info dll
11187This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11188
11189@kindex dll-symbols
11190@item dll-symbols
11191This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11192add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11193
11194@kindex set new-console
11195@item set new-console @var{mode}
11196If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11197be started in a new console on next start.
11198If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11199be started in the same console as the debugger.
11200
11201@kindex show new-console
11202@item show new-console
11203Displays whether a new console is used
11204when the debuggee is started.
11205
11206@kindex set new-group
11207@item set new-group @var{mode}
11208This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11209start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11210This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11211Ctrl-C.
11212
11213@kindex show new-group
11214@item show new-group
11215Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11216
11217@kindex set debugevents
11218@item set debugevents
11219This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11220
11221@kindex set debugexec
11222@item set debugexec
11223This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11224seen by the debugger.
11225
11226@kindex set debugexceptions
11227@item set debugexceptions
11228This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11229seen by the debugger.
11230
11231@kindex set debugmemory
11232@item set debugmemory
11233This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11234seen by the debugger.
11235
11236@kindex set shell
11237@item set shell
11238This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11239via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11240
11241@kindex show shell
11242@item show shell
11243Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11244
11245@end table
11246
be448670
CF
11247@menu
11248* Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11249@end menu
11250
11251@node Non-debug DLL symbols
11252@subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11253@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11254@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11255
11256Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11257not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11258@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11259symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11260information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11261describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11262``minimal symbols''.
11263
11264Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11265will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11266start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11267program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11268@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11269see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11270@code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11271explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11272cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11273which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11274
11275@subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11276
11277In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11278tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11279DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11280also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11281sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11282(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11283necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11284contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11285exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11286
11287Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11288though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11289symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11290some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11291@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11292@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11293
11294@smallexample
11295(gdb) info function CreateFileA
11296All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11297
11298Non-debugging symbols:
112990x77e885f4 CreateFileA
113000x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11301@end smallexample
11302
11303@smallexample
11304(gdb) info function !
11305All functions matching regular expression "!":
11306
11307Non-debugging symbols:
113080x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
113090x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
113100x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11311[etc...]
11312@end smallexample
11313
11314@subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11315
11316Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11317type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11318refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11319contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11320contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11321means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11322a function within a DLL without a running program.
11323
11324Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11325automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11326variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11327type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11328problem:
11329
11330@smallexample
11331(gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11332$1 = 268572168
11333@end smallexample
11334
11335@smallexample
11336(gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
113370x10021610: "\230y\""
11338@end smallexample
11339
11340And two possible solutions:
11341
11342@smallexample
11343(gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11344$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11345@end smallexample
11346
11347@smallexample
11348(gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
113490x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11350(gdb) x/x 0x10021608
113510x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11352(gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
113530x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11354@end smallexample
11355
11356Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11357starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11358examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11359function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11360to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11361
11362@smallexample
11363(gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11364Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11365@end smallexample
11366
11367The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11368break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11369safe.
11370
8e04817f
AC
11371@node Embedded OS
11372@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11373
8e04817f
AC
11374This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11375embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11376architectures.
d4f3574e 11377
8e04817f
AC
11378@menu
11379* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11380@end menu
104c1213 11381
8e04817f
AC
11382@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11383various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11384
8e04817f
AC
11385@node VxWorks
11386@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11387
8e04817f 11388@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11389
8e04817f 11390@table @code
104c1213 11391
8e04817f
AC
11392@kindex target vxworks
11393@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11394A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11395is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11396
8e04817f 11397@end table
104c1213 11398
8e04817f
AC
11399On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11400current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11401
8e04817f
AC
11402@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11403VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11404the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11405both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11406@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11407installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11408@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11409
8e04817f
AC
11410@table @code
11411@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11412@kindex vxworks-timeout
11413All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11414This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11415seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11416your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11417of a thin network line.
11418@end table
104c1213 11419
8e04817f
AC
11420The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11421this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11422procedures.
104c1213 11423
8e04817f
AC
11424@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11425To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11426to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11427library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11428VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11429kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11430source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11431information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11432manual.
11433@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11434
8e04817f
AC
11435Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11436your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11437run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11438@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11439
8e04817f 11440@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11441
474c8240 11442@smallexample
8e04817f 11443(vxgdb)
474c8240 11444@end smallexample
104c1213 11445
8e04817f
AC
11446@menu
11447* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11448* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11449* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11450@end menu
104c1213 11451
8e04817f
AC
11452@node VxWorks Connection
11453@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11454
8e04817f
AC
11455The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11456network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11457
474c8240 11458@smallexample
8e04817f 11459(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11460@end smallexample
104c1213 11461
8e04817f
AC
11462@need 750
11463@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11464
8e04817f
AC
11465@smallexample
11466Attaching remote machine across net...
11467Connected to tt.
11468@end smallexample
104c1213 11469
8e04817f
AC
11470@need 1000
11471@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11472loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11473these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11474path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11475to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11476
474c8240 11477@smallexample
8e04817f 11478prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11479@end smallexample
104c1213 11480
8e04817f
AC
11481When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11482the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11483command again.
104c1213 11484
8e04817f
AC
11485@node VxWorks Download
11486@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11487
8e04817f
AC
11488@cindex download to VxWorks
11489If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11490object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11491@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11492incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11493command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11494to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11495table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11496the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11497filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11498Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11499to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11500the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11501@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11502and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11503program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11504
474c8240 11505@smallexample
8e04817f 11506-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11507@end smallexample
104c1213 11508
8e04817f
AC
11509@noindent
11510Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11511
474c8240 11512@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11513(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11514(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11515@end smallexample
104c1213 11516
8e04817f 11517@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11518
8e04817f
AC
11519@smallexample
11520Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11521@end smallexample
104c1213 11522
8e04817f
AC
11523You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11524after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11525this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11526auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11527history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11528debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11529table.)
104c1213 11530
8e04817f
AC
11531@node VxWorks Attach
11532@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11533
11534@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11535You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11536follows:
11537
474c8240 11538@smallexample
104c1213 11539(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11540@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11541
11542@noindent
11543where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11544or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11545the time of attachment.
11546
6d2ebf8b 11547@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11548@section Embedded Processors
11549
11550This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11551configurations.
11552
7d86b5d5 11553
104c1213 11554@menu
104c1213
JM
11555* ARM:: ARM
11556* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11557* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
104c1213
JM
11558* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11559* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11560* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11561* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11562* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11563* PowerPC: PowerPC
11564* SH:: Hitachi SH
11565* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11566* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11567* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11568* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11569@end menu
11570
6d2ebf8b 11571@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11572@subsection ARM
11573
11574@table @code
11575
8e04817f
AC
11576@kindex target rdi
11577@item target rdi @var{dev}
11578ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11579use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11580monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11581
11582@kindex target rdp
11583@item target rdp @var{dev}
11584ARM Demon monitor.
11585
11586@end table
11587
11588@node H8/300
11589@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11590
11591@table @code
11592
11593@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11594@item target hms @var{dev}
11595A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11596Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11597line and the communications speed used.
11598
11599@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11600@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11601E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11602
11603@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11604@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11605@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11606@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11607Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11608
11609@end table
11610
11611@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11612@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11613@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11614@cindex Hitachi SH download
11615When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11616board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11617board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11618@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11619
11620@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11621Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11622
11623@enumerate
11624@item
11625that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11626for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11627emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11628the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11629H8/300, or H8/500.)
11630
11631@item
11632what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11633serial device available on your host is the default).
11634
11635@item
11636what speed to use over the serial device.
11637@end enumerate
11638
11639@menu
11640* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11641* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11642* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11643@end menu
11644
11645@node Hitachi Boards
11646@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11647
11648@c only for Unix hosts
11649@kindex device
11650@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11651Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11652need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11653first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11654hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11655
11656@kindex speed
11657@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11658@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11659speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11660hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11661the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11662@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11663
11664The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11665use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11666use a DOS host,
11667@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11668called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11669through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11670to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11671
11672The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11673program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11674sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11675the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11676
11677First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11678board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11679port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11680When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11681debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11682for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11683@code{COM2}.
11684
474c8240 11685@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11686C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11687C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11688
11689Resident portion of MODE loaded
11690
11691COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11692
474c8240 11693@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11694
11695@quotation
11696@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11697@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11698disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11699your development board.
11700@end quotation
11701
11702@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11703Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11704connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11705the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11706you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11707commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11708cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11709download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11710the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11711(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11712executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11713@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11714itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11715
11716@smallexample
11717(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11718@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11719 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11720 the conditions.
11721There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11722for details.
11723@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11724(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11725Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11726(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11727.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11728.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11729.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11730@end smallexample
11731
11732At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11733you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11734sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11735@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11736resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11737@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11738
11739Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11740available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11741you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11742
11743Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11744@itemize @bullet
11745@item
11746to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11747no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11748
11749@item
11750to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11751normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11752to detect program completion.
11753@end itemize
11754
11755In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11756development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11757
11758@node Hitachi ICE
11759@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11760
11761@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11762You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11763Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11764e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11765
11766@table @code
11767@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11768Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11769@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11770@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11771(for example, @samp{9600}).
11772
11773@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11774If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11775specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11776@end table
11777
11778@node Hitachi Special
11779@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11780
11781Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11782
11783@table @code
11784
11785@kindex set machine
11786@kindex show machine
11787@item set machine h8300
11788@itemx set machine h8300h
11789Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11790architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11791to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11792
11793@end table
11794
8e04817f
AC
11795@node H8/500
11796@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11797
11798@table @code
11799
8e04817f
AC
11800@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11801@cindex memory models, H8/500
11802@item set memory @var{mod}
11803@itemx show memory
11804Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11805@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11806memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11807@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11808
8e04817f 11809@end table
104c1213 11810
8e04817f
AC
11811@node M32R/D
11812@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11813
11814@table @code
11815
11816@kindex target m32r
11817@item target m32r @var{dev}
11818Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11819
11820@end table
11821
11822@node M68K
11823@subsection M68k
11824
11825The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11826target command for the following ROM monitors.
11827
11828@table @code
11829
11830@kindex target abug
11831@item target abug @var{dev}
11832ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11833
11834@kindex target cpu32bug
11835@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11836CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11837
11838@kindex target dbug
11839@item target dbug @var{dev}
11840dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11841
11842@kindex target est
11843@item target est @var{dev}
11844EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11845
11846@kindex target rom68k
11847@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11848ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11849
11850@end table
11851
8e04817f
AC
11852@table @code
11853
11854@kindex target rombug
11855@item target rombug @var{dev}
11856ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11857
11858@end table
11859
8e04817f
AC
11860@node MIPS Embedded
11861@subsection MIPS Embedded
11862
11863@cindex MIPS boards
11864@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11865MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11866you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11867
8e04817f
AC
11868@need 1000
11869Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11870
8e04817f
AC
11871@table @code
11872@item target mips @var{port}
11873@kindex target mips @var{port}
11874To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11875name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11876command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11877the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11878been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11879download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11880
8e04817f
AC
11881For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11882port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11883debugger:
104c1213 11884
474c8240 11885@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11886host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11887@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11888(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11889(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11890(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11891@end smallexample
104c1213 11892
8e04817f
AC
11893@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11894On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11895connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11896concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11897@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11898
8e04817f
AC
11899@item target pmon @var{port}
11900@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11901PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11902
8e04817f
AC
11903@item target ddb @var{port}
11904@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11905NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11906
8e04817f
AC
11907@item target lsi @var{port}
11908@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11909LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11910
8e04817f
AC
11911@kindex target r3900
11912@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11913Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11914
8e04817f
AC
11915@kindex target array
11916@item target array @var{dev}
11917Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11918
8e04817f 11919@end table
104c1213 11920
104c1213 11921
8e04817f
AC
11922@noindent
11923@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11924
8e04817f
AC
11925@table @code
11926@item set processor @var{args}
11927@itemx show processor
11928@kindex set processor @var{args}
11929@kindex show processor
11930Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11931processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11932For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11933to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11934Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11935is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11936@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11937
8e04817f
AC
11938@item set mipsfpu double
11939@itemx set mipsfpu single
11940@itemx set mipsfpu none
11941@itemx show mipsfpu
11942@kindex set mipsfpu
11943@kindex show mipsfpu
11944@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11945@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11946If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11947coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11948need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11949file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11950functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11951@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11952functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11953with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11954processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11955double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11956@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11957
8e04817f
AC
11958In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11959floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11960and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11961
8e04817f
AC
11962As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11963@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11964
8e04817f
AC
11965@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11966@itemx show remotedebug
11967@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11968@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11969@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11970@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11971@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11972@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11973You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11974by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11975@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11976to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11977at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11978
8e04817f
AC
11979@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11980@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11981@itemx show timeout
11982@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11983@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11984@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11985@kindex set timeout
11986@kindex show timeout
11987@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11988@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11989You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11990remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11991default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11992waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11993retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11994You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11995retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11996@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11997
8e04817f
AC
11998The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11999is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12000forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12001to run before stopping.
12002@end table
104c1213 12003
a37295f9
MM
12004@node OpenRISC 1000
12005@subsection OpenRISC 1000
12006@cindex OpenRISC 1000
12007
12008@cindex or1k boards
12009See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12010about platform and commands.
12011
12012@table @code
12013
12014@kindex target jtag
12015@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12016
12017Connects to remote JTAG server.
12018JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12019connected via parallel port to the board.
12020
12021Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12022
12023@kindex or1ksim
12024@item or1ksim @var{command}
12025If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12026Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12027
12028@kindex info or1k spr
12029@item info or1k spr
12030Displays spr groups.
12031
12032@item info or1k spr @var{group}
12033@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12034Displays register names in selected group.
12035
12036@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12037@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12038@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12039@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12040Shows information about specified spr register.
12041
12042@kindex spr
12043@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12044@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12045@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12046@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12047Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12048@end table
12049
12050Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12051It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12052program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12053triggers can be set using:
12054@table @code
12055@item $LEA/$LDATA
12056Load effective address/data
12057@item $SEA/$SDATA
12058Store effective address/data
12059@item $AEA/$ADATA
12060Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12061@item $FETCH
12062Fetch data
12063@end table
12064
12065When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12066@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12067
12068@code{htrace} commands:
12069@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12070@table @code
12071@kindex hwatch
12072@item hwatch @var{conditional}
12073Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12074or Data. For example:
12075
12076@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12077
12078@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12079
12080@kindex htrace info
12081@item htrace info
12082Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12083
12084@kindex htrace trigger
12085@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12086Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12087
12088@kindex htrace qualifier
12089@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12090Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12091
12092@kindex htrace stop
12093@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12094Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12095
12096@kindex htrace record
f153cc92 12097@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
a37295f9
MM
12098Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12099triggered.
12100
12101@kindex htrace enable
12102@item htrace enable
12103@kindex htrace disable
12104@itemx htrace disable
12105Enables/disables the HW trace.
12106
12107@kindex htrace rewind
f153cc92 12108@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
a37295f9
MM
12109Clears currently recorded trace data.
12110
12111If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12112will be written there.
12113
12114@kindex htrace print
f153cc92 12115@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
a37295f9
MM
12116Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12117
12118@kindex htrace mode continuous
12119@item htrace mode continuous
12120Set continuous trace mode.
12121
12122@kindex htrace mode suspend
12123@item htrace mode suspend
12124Set suspend trace mode.
12125
12126@end table
12127
8e04817f
AC
12128@node PowerPC
12129@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
12130
12131@table @code
104c1213 12132
8e04817f
AC
12133@kindex target dink32
12134@item target dink32 @var{dev}
12135DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 12136
8e04817f
AC
12137@kindex target ppcbug
12138@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12139@kindex target ppcbug1
12140@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12141PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 12142
8e04817f
AC
12143@kindex target sds
12144@item target sds @var{dev}
12145SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12146
12147@end table
12148
12149@node PA
12150@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
12151
12152@table @code
12153
8e04817f
AC
12154@kindex target op50n
12155@item target op50n @var{dev}
12156OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12157
12158@kindex target w89k
12159@item target w89k @var{dev}
12160W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
12161
12162@end table
12163
8e04817f
AC
12164@node SH
12165@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
12166
12167@table @code
12168
8e04817f
AC
12169@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12170@item target hms @var{dev}
12171A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12172commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12173the communications speed used.
104c1213 12174
8e04817f
AC
12175@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12176@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12177E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 12178
8e04817f
AC
12179@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12180@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12181@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12182@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12183Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 12184
8e04817f 12185@end table
104c1213 12186
8e04817f
AC
12187@node Sparclet
12188@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 12189
8e04817f
AC
12190@cindex Sparclet
12191
12192@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12193Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12194@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12195both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12196@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12197
8e04817f
AC
12198@table @code
12199@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12200@kindex remotetimeout
12201@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12202This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12203seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12204@end table
12205
8e04817f
AC
12206@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12207When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12208information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12209load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12210@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12211
474c8240 12212@smallexample
8e04817f 12213sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12214@end smallexample
104c1213 12215
8e04817f 12216You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12217
474c8240 12218@smallexample
8e04817f 12219sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12220@end smallexample
104c1213 12221
8e04817f
AC
12222@cindex running, on Sparclet
12223Once you have set
12224your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12225run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12226(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12227
8e04817f
AC
12228@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12229
474c8240 12230@smallexample
8e04817f 12231(gdbslet)
474c8240 12232@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12233
12234@menu
8e04817f
AC
12235* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12236* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12237* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12238* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12239@end menu
12240
8e04817f
AC
12241@node Sparclet File
12242@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12243
8e04817f 12244The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12245
474c8240 12246@smallexample
8e04817f 12247(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12248@end smallexample
104c1213 12249
8e04817f
AC
12250@need 1000
12251@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12252@value{GDBN} locates
12253the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12254path.
12255If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12256files will be searched as well.
12257@value{GDBN} locates
12258the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12259path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12260If it fails
12261to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12262
474c8240 12263@smallexample
8e04817f 12264prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12265@end smallexample
104c1213 12266
8e04817f
AC
12267When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12268the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12269@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12270
8e04817f
AC
12271@node Sparclet Connection
12272@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12273
8e04817f
AC
12274The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12275To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12276
474c8240 12277@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12278(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12279Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12280main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12281@end smallexample
104c1213 12282
8e04817f
AC
12283@need 750
12284@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12285
474c8240 12286@smallexample
8e04817f 12287Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12288@end smallexample
104c1213 12289
8e04817f
AC
12290@node Sparclet Download
12291@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12292
8e04817f
AC
12293@cindex download to Sparclet
12294Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12295you can use the @value{GDBN}
12296@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12297The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12298command.
12299Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12300address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12301offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12302of each of the file's sections.
12303For instance, if the program
12304@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12305and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12306
474c8240 12307@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12308(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12309Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12310@end smallexample
104c1213 12311
8e04817f
AC
12312If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12313to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12314to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12315
12316@node Sparclet Execution
12317@subsubsection Running and debugging
12318
12319@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12320You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12321commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12322manual for the list of commands.
12323
474c8240 12324@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12325(gdbslet) b main
12326Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12327(gdbslet) run
12328Starting program: prog
12329Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
123303 char *symarg = 0;
12331(gdbslet) step
123324 char *execarg = "hello!";
12333(gdbslet)
474c8240 12334@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12335
12336@node Sparclite
12337@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12338
12339@table @code
12340
8e04817f
AC
12341@kindex target sparclite
12342@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12343Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12344You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12345For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12346remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12347
12348@end table
12349
8e04817f
AC
12350@node ST2000
12351@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12352
8e04817f
AC
12353@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12354STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12355
8e04817f
AC
12356To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12357manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12358
474c8240 12359@smallexample
8e04817f 12360target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12361@end smallexample
104c1213 12362
8e04817f
AC
12363@noindent
12364to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12365the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12366ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12367connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12368concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12369
8e04817f
AC
12370The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12371this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12372would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12373(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12374available on your host computer.
12375@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12376@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12377
8e04817f
AC
12378@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12379These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12380environment:
104c1213 12381
8e04817f
AC
12382@table @code
12383@item st2000 @var{command}
12384@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12385@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12386@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12387Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12388manual for available commands.
104c1213 12389
8e04817f
AC
12390@item connect
12391@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12392Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12393you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12394sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12395@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12396@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12397@end table
12398
8e04817f
AC
12399@node Z8000
12400@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12401
8e04817f
AC
12402@cindex Z8000
12403@cindex simulator, Z8000
12404@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12405
8e04817f
AC
12406When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12407a Z8000 simulator.
12408
12409For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12410unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12411segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12412appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12413
8e04817f
AC
12414@table @code
12415@item target sim @var{args}
12416@kindex sim
12417@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12418Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12419options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12420@end table
12421
8e04817f
AC
12422@noindent
12423After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12424CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12425@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12426to run your program, and so on.
12427
12428As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12429(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12430additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12431
12432@table @code
12433
8e04817f
AC
12434@item cycles
12435Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12436
8e04817f
AC
12437@item insts
12438Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12439
8e04817f
AC
12440@item time
12441Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12442
8e04817f 12443@end table
104c1213 12444
8e04817f
AC
12445You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12446conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12447conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12448simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12449
8e04817f
AC
12450@node Architectures
12451@section Architectures
104c1213 12452
8e04817f
AC
12453This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12454all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12455
8e04817f
AC
12456@menu
12457* A29K::
12458* Alpha::
12459* MIPS::
12460@end menu
104c1213 12461
8e04817f
AC
12462@node A29K
12463@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12464
12465@table @code
104c1213 12466
8e04817f
AC
12467@kindex set rstack_high_address
12468@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12469@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12470@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12471On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12472@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12473extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12474stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12475memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12476this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12477the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12478address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12479hexadecimal.
104c1213 12480
8e04817f
AC
12481@kindex show rstack_high_address
12482@item show rstack_high_address
12483Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12484processors.
104c1213 12485
8e04817f 12486@end table
104c1213 12487
8e04817f
AC
12488@node Alpha
12489@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12490
8e04817f 12491See the following section.
104c1213 12492
8e04817f
AC
12493@node MIPS
12494@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12495
8e04817f
AC
12496@cindex stack on Alpha
12497@cindex stack on MIPS
12498@cindex Alpha stack
12499@cindex MIPS stack
12500Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12501sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12502find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12503
8e04817f
AC
12504@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12505To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12506@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12507you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12508commands:
104c1213 12509
8e04817f
AC
12510@table @code
12511@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12512@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12513Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12514search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12515default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12516larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12517and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12518
8e04817f
AC
12519@item show heuristic-fence-post
12520Display the current limit.
12521@end table
104c1213
JM
12522
12523@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12524These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12525for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12526
104c1213 12527
8e04817f
AC
12528@node Controlling GDB
12529@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12530
12531You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12532@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12533data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12534described here.
12535
12536@menu
12537* Prompt:: Prompt
12538* Editing:: Command editing
12539* History:: Command history
12540* Screen Size:: Screen size
12541* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12542* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12543* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12544* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12545@end menu
12546
12547@node Prompt
12548@section Prompt
104c1213 12549
8e04817f 12550@cindex prompt
104c1213 12551
8e04817f
AC
12552@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12553called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12554can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12555instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12556the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12557which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12558
8e04817f
AC
12559@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12560prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12561or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12562
8e04817f
AC
12563@table @code
12564@kindex set prompt
12565@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12566Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12567
8e04817f
AC
12568@kindex show prompt
12569@item show prompt
12570Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12571@end table
12572
8e04817f
AC
12573@node Editing
12574@section Command editing
12575@cindex readline
12576@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12577
8e04817f
AC
12578@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12579@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12580command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12581or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12582substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12583debugging sessions.
104c1213 12584
8e04817f
AC
12585You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12586command @code{set}.
104c1213 12587
8e04817f
AC
12588@table @code
12589@kindex set editing
12590@cindex editing
12591@item set editing
12592@itemx set editing on
12593Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12594
8e04817f
AC
12595@item set editing off
12596Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12597
8e04817f
AC
12598@kindex show editing
12599@item show editing
12600Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12601@end table
12602
8e04817f
AC
12603@node History
12604@section Command history
12605
12606@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12607debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12608happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12609history facility.
104c1213
JM
12610
12611@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12612@cindex history substitution
12613@cindex history file
12614@kindex set history filename
12615@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12616@item set history filename @var{fname}
12617Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12618This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12619list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12620exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12621the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12622to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12623@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12624is not set.
104c1213 12625
8e04817f
AC
12626@cindex history save
12627@kindex set history save
12628@item set history save
12629@itemx set history save on
12630Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12631@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12632
8e04817f
AC
12633@item set history save off
12634Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12635
8e04817f
AC
12636@cindex history size
12637@kindex set history size
12638@item set history size @var{size}
12639Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12640This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12641@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12642@end table
12643
8e04817f
AC
12644@cindex history expansion
12645History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12646@ifset have-readline-appendices
12647@xref{Event Designators}.
12648@end ifset
12649
12650Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12651is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12652@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12653follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12654a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12655history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12656@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12657
12658The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12659
12660@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12661@kindex set history expansion
12662@item set history expansion on
12663@itemx set history expansion
12664Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12665
8e04817f
AC
12666@item set history expansion off
12667Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12668
8e04817f
AC
12669The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12670editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12671or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12672@ifset have-readline-appendices
12673@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12674@end ifset
104c1213 12675
8e04817f
AC
12676@c @group
12677@kindex show history
12678@item show history
12679@itemx show history filename
12680@itemx show history save
12681@itemx show history size
12682@itemx show history expansion
12683These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12684@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12685@c @end group
12686@end table
12687
12688@table @code
12689@kindex shows
12690@item show commands
12691Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12692
8e04817f
AC
12693@item show commands @var{n}
12694Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12695
12696@item show commands +
12697Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12698@end table
12699
8e04817f
AC
12700@node Screen Size
12701@section Screen size
12702@cindex size of screen
12703@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12704
8e04817f
AC
12705Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12706information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12707@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12708output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12709to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12710determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12711printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12712rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12713
12714Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12715driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12716together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12717@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12718you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12719width} commands:
12720
12721@table @code
12722@kindex set height
12723@kindex set width
12724@kindex show width
12725@kindex show height
12726@item set height @var{lpp}
12727@itemx show height
12728@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12729@itemx show width
12730These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12731a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12732commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12733
8e04817f
AC
12734If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12735output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12736file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12737
8e04817f
AC
12738Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12739from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12740@end table
12741
8e04817f
AC
12742@node Numbers
12743@section Numbers
12744@cindex number representation
12745@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12746
8e04817f
AC
12747You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12748@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12749@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12750begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12751default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12752numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12753change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12754radix} command.
104c1213 12755
8e04817f
AC
12756@table @code
12757@kindex set input-radix
12758@item set input-radix @var{base}
12759Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12760for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12761specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12762example, any of
104c1213 12763
8e04817f
AC
12764@smallexample
12765set radix 012
12766set radix 10.
12767set radix 0xa
12768@end smallexample
104c1213 12769
8e04817f
AC
12770@noindent
12771sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12772leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12773
8e04817f
AC
12774@kindex set output-radix
12775@item set output-radix @var{base}
12776Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12777for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12778specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12779
8e04817f
AC
12780@kindex show input-radix
12781@item show input-radix
12782Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12783
8e04817f
AC
12784@kindex show output-radix
12785@item show output-radix
12786Display the current default base for numeric display.
12787@end table
104c1213 12788
1e698235
DJ
12789@node ABI
12790@section Configuring the current ABI
12791
12792@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12793application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12794conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12795current ABI.
12796
98b45e30
DJ
12797@cindex OS ABI
12798@kindex set osabi
b4e9345d 12799@kindex show osabi
98b45e30
DJ
12800
12801One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12802system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12803@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12804but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12805One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12806an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12807not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12808platform provides.
12809
12810@table @code
12811@item show osabi
12812Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12813
12814@item set osabi
12815With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12816
12817@item set osabi @var{abi}
12818Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12819@end table
12820
1e698235
DJ
12821@cindex float promotion
12822@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12823
12824Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12825function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12826(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12827according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12828(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12829@code{double} and then passed.
12830
12831Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12832a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12833as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12834
12835@table @code
12836@item set coerce-float-to-double
12837@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12838Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12839to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12840
12841@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12842Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12843functions.
12844@end table
12845
f1212245
DJ
12846@kindex set cp-abi
12847@kindex show cp-abi
12848@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
12849objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
12850used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
12851programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
12852multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
12853program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
12854Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
12855before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
12856``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
12857use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
12858``auto''.
12859
12860@table @code
12861@item show cp-abi
12862Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
12863
12864@item set cp-abi
12865With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
12866
12867@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
12868@itemx set cp-abi auto
12869Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
12870@end table
12871
8e04817f
AC
12872@node Messages/Warnings
12873@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12874
8e04817f
AC
12875By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12876running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12877command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12878internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12879
8e04817f
AC
12880Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12881which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12882see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12883
8e04817f
AC
12884@table @code
12885@kindex set verbose
12886@item set verbose on
12887Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12888
8e04817f
AC
12889@item set verbose off
12890Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12891
8e04817f
AC
12892@kindex show verbose
12893@item show verbose
12894Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12895@end table
104c1213 12896
8e04817f
AC
12897By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12898object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12899find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12900symbol files}).
104c1213 12901
8e04817f 12902@table @code
104c1213 12903
8e04817f
AC
12904@kindex set complaints
12905@item set complaints @var{limit}
12906Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12907unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12908@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12909to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12910
8e04817f
AC
12911@kindex show complaints
12912@item show complaints
12913Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12914
8e04817f 12915@end table
104c1213 12916
8e04817f
AC
12917By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12918lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12919you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12920
474c8240 12921@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12922(@value{GDBP}) run
12923The program being debugged has been started already.
12924Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12925@end smallexample
104c1213 12926
8e04817f
AC
12927If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12928commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12929
8e04817f 12930@table @code
104c1213 12931
8e04817f
AC
12932@kindex set confirm
12933@cindex flinching
12934@cindex confirmation
12935@cindex stupid questions
12936@item set confirm off
12937Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12938
8e04817f
AC
12939@item set confirm on
12940Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12941
8e04817f
AC
12942@kindex show confirm
12943@item show confirm
12944Displays state of confirmation requests.
12945
12946@end table
104c1213 12947
8e04817f
AC
12948@node Debugging Output
12949@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12950@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12951@kindex set debug arch
12952@item set debug arch
12953Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12954@kindex show debug arch
12955@item show debug arch
12956Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12957@kindex set debug event
12958@item set debug event
12959Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12960default is off.
12961@kindex show debug event
12962@item show debug event
12963Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12964info.
12965@kindex set debug expression
12966@item set debug expression
12967Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12968default is off.
12969@kindex show debug expression
12970@item show debug expression
12971Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12972debugging info.
7453dc06
AC
12973@kindex set debug frame
12974@item set debug frame
12975Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
12976default is off.
12977@kindex show debug frame
12978@item show debug frame
12979Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
12980info.
8e04817f
AC
12981@kindex set debug overload
12982@item set debug overload
12983Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12984info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12985is off.
12986@kindex show debug overload
12987@item show debug overload
12988Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12989debugging info.
12990@kindex set debug remote
12991@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12992@cindex serial connections, debugging
12993@item set debug remote
12994Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12995the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12996@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12997@kindex show debug remote
12998@item show debug remote
12999Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13000@kindex set debug serial
13001@item set debug serial
13002Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13003default is off.
13004@kindex show debug serial
13005@item show debug serial
13006Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13007info.
13008@kindex set debug target
13009@item set debug target
13010Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13011includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13012default is off.
13013@kindex show debug target
13014@item show debug target
13015Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13016info.
13017@kindex set debug varobj
13018@item set debug varobj
13019Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13020info. The default is off.
13021@kindex show debug varobj
13022@item show debug varobj
13023Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13024debugging info.
13025@end table
104c1213 13026
8e04817f
AC
13027@node Sequences
13028@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 13029
8e04817f
AC
13030Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13031command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13032commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13033files.
104c1213 13034
8e04817f
AC
13035@menu
13036* Define:: User-defined commands
13037* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13038* Command Files:: Command files
13039* Output:: Commands for controlled output
13040@end menu
104c1213 13041
8e04817f
AC
13042@node Define
13043@section User-defined commands
104c1213 13044
8e04817f
AC
13045@cindex user-defined command
13046A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13047which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13048@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13049separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13050via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 13051
8e04817f
AC
13052@smallexample
13053define adder
13054 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13055@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
13056
13057@noindent
8e04817f 13058To execute the command use:
104c1213 13059
8e04817f
AC
13060@smallexample
13061adder 1 2 3
13062@end smallexample
104c1213 13063
8e04817f
AC
13064@noindent
13065This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13066its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13067reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13068functions calls.
104c1213
JM
13069
13070@table @code
104c1213 13071
8e04817f
AC
13072@kindex define
13073@item define @var{commandname}
13074Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13075by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 13076
8e04817f
AC
13077The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13078which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13079commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13080
8e04817f
AC
13081@kindex if
13082@kindex else
13083@item if
13084Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13085It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13086only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13087There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13088by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13089was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13090
8e04817f
AC
13091@kindex while
13092@item while
13093The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13094which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13095execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13096The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13097evaluates to true.
104c1213 13098
8e04817f
AC
13099@kindex document
13100@item document @var{commandname}
13101Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13102accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13103defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13104reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13105After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13106@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 13107
8e04817f
AC
13108You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13109documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13110does not change the documentation.
104c1213 13111
8e04817f
AC
13112@kindex help user-defined
13113@item help user-defined
13114List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13115(if any) for each.
104c1213 13116
8e04817f
AC
13117@kindex show user
13118@item show user
13119@itemx show user @var{commandname}
13120Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13121not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13122definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 13123
20f01a46
DH
13124@kindex show max-user-call-depth
13125@kindex set max-user-call-depth
13126@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
13127@itemx set max-user-call-depth
13128The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13129levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13130infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 13131
104c1213
JM
13132@end table
13133
8e04817f
AC
13134When user-defined commands are executed, the
13135commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13136stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 13137
8e04817f
AC
13138If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13139without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13140commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13141messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 13142
8e04817f
AC
13143@node Hooks
13144@section User-defined command hooks
13145@cindex command hooks
13146@cindex hooks, for commands
13147@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 13148
8e04817f
AC
13149@kindex hook
13150@kindex hook-
13151You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13152command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13153command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13154before that command.
104c1213 13155
8e04817f
AC
13156@cindex hooks, post-command
13157@kindex hookpost
13158@kindex hookpost-
13159A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13160Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13161@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13162that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13163pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 13164
8e04817f
AC
13165It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13166occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 13167
8e04817f
AC
13168@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13169@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 13170
8e04817f
AC
13171@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13172In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13173(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13174execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13175displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 13176
8e04817f
AC
13177For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13178single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13179you could define:
104c1213 13180
474c8240 13181@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13182define hook-stop
13183handle SIGALRM nopass
13184end
104c1213 13185
8e04817f
AC
13186define hook-run
13187handle SIGALRM pass
13188end
104c1213 13189
8e04817f
AC
13190define hook-continue
13191handle SIGLARM pass
13192end
474c8240 13193@end smallexample
104c1213 13194
8e04817f
AC
13195As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13196command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13197you could define:
104c1213 13198
474c8240 13199@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13200define hook-echo
13201echo <<<---
13202end
104c1213 13203
8e04817f
AC
13204define hookpost-echo
13205echo --->>>\n
13206end
104c1213 13207
8e04817f
AC
13208(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13209<<<---Hello World--->>>
13210(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 13211
474c8240 13212@end smallexample
104c1213 13213
8e04817f
AC
13214You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13215not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13216name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13217@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13218@c or not?
13219If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13220@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13221(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 13222
8e04817f
AC
13223If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13224get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 13225
8e04817f
AC
13226@node Command Files
13227@section Command files
c906108c 13228
8e04817f
AC
13229@cindex command files
13230A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13231commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13232An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13233the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13234
8e04817f
AC
13235@cindex init file
13236@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13237@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13238When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13239@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13240port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13241limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13242During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13243
8e04817f
AC
13244@enumerate
13245@item
13246Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13247DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13248@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13249
8e04817f
AC
13250@item
13251Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13252
8e04817f
AC
13253@item
13254Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13255
8e04817f
AC
13256@item
13257Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13258@end enumerate
c906108c 13259
8e04817f
AC
13260The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13261complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13262and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13263option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13264
8e04817f
AC
13265@cindex init file name
13266On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13267different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13268form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13269different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13270environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13271
8e04817f
AC
13272@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13273@itemize @bullet
13274@item
13275VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13276
8e04817f
AC
13277@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13278@item
13279OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13280
8e04817f
AC
13281@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13282@item
13283ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13284@end itemize
c906108c 13285
8e04817f
AC
13286You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13287@code{source} command:
c906108c 13288
8e04817f
AC
13289@table @code
13290@kindex source
13291@item source @var{filename}
13292Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13293@end table
13294
8e04817f 13295The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13296printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13297execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13298
8e04817f
AC
13299Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13300without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13301normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13302when called from command files.
c906108c 13303
8e04817f
AC
13304@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13305mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13306standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13307not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13308the next command.
c906108c 13309
474c8240 13310@smallexample
8e04817f 13311gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13312@end smallexample
c906108c 13313
8e04817f
AC
13314(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13315will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13316would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13317
8e04817f
AC
13318@node Output
13319@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13320
8e04817f
AC
13321During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13322@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13323explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13324describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13325want.
c906108c
SS
13326
13327@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13328@kindex echo
13329@item echo @var{text}
13330@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13331@c because it is not in ANSI.
13332Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13333@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13334newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13335In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13336by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13337string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13338trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13339To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13340@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13341
8e04817f
AC
13342A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13343the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13344
474c8240 13345@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13346echo This is some text\n\
13347which is continued\n\
13348onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13349@end smallexample
c906108c 13350
8e04817f 13351produces the same output as
c906108c 13352
474c8240 13353@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13354echo This is some text\n
13355echo which is continued\n
13356echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13357@end smallexample
c906108c 13358
8e04817f
AC
13359@kindex output
13360@item output @var{expression}
13361Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13362newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13363value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13364on expressions.
c906108c 13365
8e04817f
AC
13366@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13367Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13368the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13369formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13370
8e04817f
AC
13371@kindex printf
13372@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13373Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13374@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13375either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13376@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13377subroutine
13378@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13379@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13380@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13381@c supported.
c906108c 13382
474c8240 13383@smallexample
8e04817f 13384printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13385@end smallexample
c906108c 13386
8e04817f 13387For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13388
8e04817f
AC
13389@smallexample
13390printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13391@end smallexample
c906108c 13392
8e04817f
AC
13393The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13394string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13395letter.
c906108c
SS
13396@end table
13397
21c294e6
AC
13398@node Interpreters
13399@chapter Command Interpreters
13400@cindex command interpreters
13401
13402@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13403infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13404between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13405
13406@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13407interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13408and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13409describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13410
13411By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13412However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13413interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13414startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13415
13416@table @code
13417@item console
13418@cindex console interpreter
13419The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13420used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13421@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13422
13423@item mi
13424@cindex mi interpreter
13425The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13426by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13427or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13428Interface}.
13429
13430@item mi2
13431@cindex mi2 interpreter
13432The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13433
13434@item mi1
13435@cindex mi1 interpreter
13436The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13437
13438@end table
13439
13440@cindex invoke another interpreter
13441The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13442switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13443precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13444enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13445@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13446the IDE inoperable!
13447
13448@kindex interpreter-exec
13449Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13450commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13451command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13452@code{interpreter-exec} command:
13453
13454@smallexample
13455interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13456@end smallexample
13457
13458@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13459@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13460
8e04817f
AC
13461@node TUI
13462@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13463@cindex TUI
c906108c 13464
8e04817f
AC
13465@menu
13466* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13467* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13468* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13469* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13470* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13471@end menu
c906108c 13472
8e04817f
AC
13473The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13474is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13475to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13476and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13477The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13478with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13479
8e04817f
AC
13480@node TUI Overview
13481@section TUI overview
c906108c 13482
8e04817f
AC
13483The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13484@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13485
8e04817f
AC
13486@itemize @bullet
13487@item
13488A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13489windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13490
8e04817f
AC
13491@item
13492A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13493the TUI.
13494@end itemize
c906108c 13495
8e04817f
AC
13496In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13497on the terminal:
c906108c 13498
8e04817f
AC
13499@table @emph
13500@item command
13501This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13502prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13503managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13504window is always visible.
c906108c 13505
8e04817f
AC
13506@item source
13507The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13508line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13509
8e04817f
AC
13510@item assembly
13511The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13512
8e04817f
AC
13513@item register
13514This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13515a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13516changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13517
c906108c
SS
13518@end table
13519
269c21fe
SC
13520The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13521by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13522Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13523indicates the breakpoint type:
13524
13525@table @code
13526@item B
13527Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13528
13529@item b
13530Breakpoint which was never hit.
13531
13532@item H
13533Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13534
13535@item h
13536Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13537
13538@end table
13539
13540The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13541
13542@table @code
13543@item +
13544Breakpoint is enabled.
13545
13546@item -
13547Breakpoint is disabled.
13548
13549@end table
13550
8e04817f
AC
13551The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13552and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13553changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13554These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13555layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13556The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13557
8e04817f
AC
13558@itemize @bullet
13559@item
13560source
2df3850c 13561
8e04817f
AC
13562@item
13563assembly
13564
13565@item
13566source and assembly
13567
13568@item
13569source and registers
c906108c 13570
8e04817f
AC
13571@item
13572assembly and registers
2df3850c 13573
8e04817f 13574@end itemize
c906108c 13575
b7bb15bc
SC
13576On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13577concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13578updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13579are displayed:
13580
13581@table @emph
13582@item target
13583Indicates the current gdb target
13584(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13585
13586@item process
13587Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13588When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13589
13590@item function
13591Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13592The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13593When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13594the string @code{??} is displayed.
13595
13596@item line
13597Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13598When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13599
13600@item pc
13601Indicates the current program counter address.
13602
13603@end table
13604
8e04817f
AC
13605@node TUI Keys
13606@section TUI Key Bindings
13607@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13608
8e04817f
AC
13609The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13610(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13611They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13612directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13613a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13614@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13615are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13616
8e04817f
AC
13617@table @kbd
13618@kindex C-x C-a
13619@item C-x C-a
13620@kindex C-x a
13621@itemx C-x a
13622@kindex C-x A
13623@itemx C-x A
13624Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13625the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13626its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13627mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13628The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13629
8e04817f
AC
13630@kindex C-x 1
13631@item C-x 1
13632Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13633either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13634is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13635
8e04817f 13636Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13637
8e04817f
AC
13638@kindex C-x 2
13639@item C-x 2
13640Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13641layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13642When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13643previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13644
8e04817f 13645Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13646
7cf36c78
SC
13647@kindex C-x s
13648@item C-x s
13649Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13650(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13651
c906108c
SS
13652@end table
13653
8e04817f 13654The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13655
8e04817f
AC
13656@table @key
13657@kindex PgUp
13658@item PgUp
13659Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13660
8e04817f
AC
13661@kindex PgDn
13662@item PgDn
13663Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13664
8e04817f
AC
13665@kindex Up
13666@item Up
13667Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13668
8e04817f
AC
13669@kindex Down
13670@item Down
13671Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13672
8e04817f
AC
13673@kindex Left
13674@item Left
13675Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13676
8e04817f
AC
13677@kindex Right
13678@item Right
13679Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13680
8e04817f
AC
13681@kindex C-L
13682@item C-L
13683Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13684
8e04817f 13685@end table
c906108c 13686
8e04817f
AC
13687In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13688for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13689necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13690@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13691
7cf36c78
SC
13692@node TUI Single Key Mode
13693@section TUI Single Key Mode
13694@cindex TUI single key mode
13695
13696The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13697key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13698some gdb commands.
13699
13700@table @kbd
13701@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13702@item c
13703continue
13704
13705@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13706@item d
13707down
13708
13709@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13710@item f
13711finish
13712
13713@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13714@item n
13715next
13716
13717@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13718@item q
13719exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13720
13721@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13722@item r
13723run
13724
13725@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13726@item s
13727step
13728
13729@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13730@item u
13731up
13732
13733@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13734@item v
13735info locals
13736
13737@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13738@item w
13739where
13740
13741@end table
13742
13743Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13744The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13745it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13746with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13747@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13748this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13749
13750
8e04817f
AC
13751@node TUI Commands
13752@section TUI specific commands
13753@cindex TUI commands
13754
13755The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13756These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13757the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13758is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13759in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13760
13761@table @code
3d757584
SC
13762@item info win
13763@kindex info win
13764List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13765
8e04817f
AC
13766@item layout next
13767@kindex layout next
13768Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13769
8e04817f
AC
13770@item layout prev
13771@kindex layout prev
13772Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13773
8e04817f
AC
13774@item layout src
13775@kindex layout src
13776Display the source window only.
c906108c 13777
8e04817f
AC
13778@item layout asm
13779@kindex layout asm
13780Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13781
8e04817f
AC
13782@item layout split
13783@kindex layout split
13784Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13785
8e04817f
AC
13786@item layout regs
13787@kindex layout regs
13788Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13789
13790@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13791@kindex focus
13792Set the focus to the named window.
13793This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13794can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13795
8e04817f
AC
13796@item refresh
13797@kindex refresh
13798Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13799
8e04817f
AC
13800@item update
13801@kindex update
13802Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13803
8e04817f
AC
13804@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13805@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13806@kindex winheight
13807Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13808lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13809decrease it.
2df3850c 13810
c906108c
SS
13811@end table
13812
8e04817f
AC
13813@node TUI Configuration
13814@section TUI configuration variables
13815@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13816
8e04817f
AC
13817The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13818appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13819
8e04817f
AC
13820@table @code
13821@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13822@kindex set tui border-kind
13823Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13824The possible values are the following:
13825@table @code
13826@item space
13827Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13828
8e04817f
AC
13829@item ascii
13830Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13831
8e04817f
AC
13832@item acs
13833Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13834drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13835
8e04817f 13836@end table
c78b4128 13837
8e04817f
AC
13838@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13839@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13840Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13841The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13842@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13843
8e04817f
AC
13844@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13845@kindex set tui border-mode
13846Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13847The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13848@table @code
13849@item normal
13850Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13851
8e04817f
AC
13852@item standout
13853Use standout mode.
c906108c 13854
8e04817f
AC
13855@item reverse
13856Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13857
8e04817f
AC
13858@item half
13859Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13860
8e04817f
AC
13861@item half-standout
13862Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13863
8e04817f
AC
13864@item bold
13865Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13866
8e04817f
AC
13867@item bold-standout
13868Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13869
8e04817f 13870@end table
c78b4128 13871
8e04817f 13872@end table
c78b4128 13873
8e04817f
AC
13874@node Emacs
13875@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13876
8e04817f
AC
13877@cindex Emacs
13878@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13879A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13880edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13881@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13882
8e04817f
AC
13883To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13884executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13885@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13886created Emacs buffer.
13887@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13888
8e04817f
AC
13889Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13890things:
c906108c 13891
8e04817f
AC
13892@itemize @bullet
13893@item
13894All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13895@end itemize
c906108c 13896
8e04817f
AC
13897This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13898and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13899
8e04817f
AC
13900This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13901commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13902in this way.
bf0184be 13903
8e04817f
AC
13904All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13905with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13906way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13907stop.
bf0184be 13908
8e04817f 13909@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13910@item
8e04817f
AC
13911@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13912@end itemize
bf0184be 13913
8e04817f
AC
13914Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13915source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13916left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13917source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13918and the source.
bf0184be 13919
8e04817f
AC
13920Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13921usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13922
8e04817f
AC
13923@quotation
13924@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13925current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13926the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13927appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13928environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13929session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13930back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13931avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13932your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13933@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13934
8e04817f
AC
13935A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13936switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13937@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13938@end quotation
13939
13940By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13941you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13942several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13943Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13944
474c8240 13945@smallexample
8e04817f 13946(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13947@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13948
13949@noindent
13950(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13951in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13952``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13953
13954In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13955addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13956
8e04817f
AC
13957@table @kbd
13958@item C-h m
13959Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13960
8e04817f
AC
13961@item M-s
13962Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13963update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13964
8e04817f
AC
13965@item M-n
13966Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13967calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13968to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13969
8e04817f
AC
13970@item M-i
13971Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13972display window accordingly.
c906108c 13973
8e04817f
AC
13974@item M-x gdb-nexti
13975Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13976display window accordingly.
c906108c 13977
8e04817f
AC
13978@item C-c C-f
13979Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13980@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13981
8e04817f
AC
13982@item M-c
13983Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13984command.
b433d00b 13985
8e04817f 13986@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13987
8e04817f
AC
13988@item M-u
13989Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13990(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13991like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13992
8e04817f 13993@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13994
8e04817f
AC
13995@item M-d
13996Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13997@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13998
8e04817f 13999@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 14000
8e04817f
AC
14001@item C-x &
14002Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
14003of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
14004around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
14005then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
14006argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 14007
8e04817f
AC
14008You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
14009@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
14010otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
14011inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
14012wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
14013list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
14014formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
14015is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
14016@end table
c906108c 14017
8e04817f
AC
14018In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
14019tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 14020
8e04817f
AC
14021If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14022it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14023request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14024the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14025frame.
c906108c 14026
8e04817f
AC
14027The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14028which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14029the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14030communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14031delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14032to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 14033
8e04817f
AC
14034@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14035@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14036@ignore
14037@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14038@kindex Epoch
14039@kindex inspect
c906108c 14040
8e04817f
AC
14041Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14042called the @code{epoch}
14043environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14044@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14045each value is printed in its own window.
14046@end ignore
c906108c 14047
922fbb7b
AC
14048
14049@node GDB/MI
14050@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
14051
14052@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
14053
14054@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
14055@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to @value{GDBN}. It is
14056specifically intended to support the development of systems which use
14057the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
14058
14059This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
14060in the form of a reference manual.
14061
14062Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
14063features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
14064
14065@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
14066
14067@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
14068This chapter uses the following notation:
14069
14070@itemize @bullet
14071@item
14072@code{|} separates two alternatives.
14073
14074@item
14075@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
14076it may or may not be given.
14077
14078@item
14079@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14080may repeat zero or more times.
14081
14082@item
14083@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14084may repeat one or more times.
14085
14086@item
14087@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
14088@end itemize
14089
14090@ignore
14091@heading Dependencies
14092@end ignore
14093
14094@heading Acknowledgments
14095
14096In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
14097Elena Zannoni.
14098
14099@menu
14100* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
14101* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
14102* GDB/MI Output Records::
14103* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
14104* GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
14105* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
14106* GDB/MI Program Control::
14107* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
14108@ignore
14109* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
14110* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
14111* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
14112@end ignore
14113* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
14114* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
14115* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
14116* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
14117* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
14118* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
14119@end menu
14120
14121@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14122@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
14123@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
14124
14125@menu
14126* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
14127* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
14128* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
14129@end menu
14130
14131@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
14132@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
14133
14134@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
14135@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
14136@table @code
14137@item @var{command} @expansion{}
14138@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
14139
14140@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
14141@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
14142@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14143
14144@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
14145@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
14146@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
14147
14148@item @var{token} @expansion{}
14149"any sequence of digits"
14150
14151@item @var{option} @expansion{}
14152@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
14153
14154@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
14155@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
14156
14157@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
14158@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
14159
14160@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
14161@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
14162"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
14163
14164@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
14165@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
14166
14167@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14168@code{CR | CR-LF}
14169@end table
14170
14171@noindent
14172Notes:
14173
14174@itemize @bullet
14175@item
14176The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
14177output is described below.
14178
14179@item
14180The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
14181finishes.
14182
14183@item
14184Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
14185list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
14186followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
14187parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
14188@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
14189@end itemize
14190
14191Pragmatics:
14192
14193@itemize @bullet
14194@item
14195We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
14196
14197@item
14198We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
14199@end itemize
14200
14201@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
14202@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
14203
14204@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
14205@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
14206The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
14207followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
14208is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
14209terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
14210
14211If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
14212corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
14213@var{token}.
14214
14215@table @code
14216@item @var{output} @expansion{}
14217@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
14218
14219@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
14220@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14221
14222@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
14223@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
14224
14225@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
14226@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
14227
14228@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
14229@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
14230
14231@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
14232@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
14233
14234@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
14235@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
14236
14237@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
14238@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14239
14240@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
14241@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
14242
14243@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
14244@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
14245depending on the needs---this is still in development).
14246
14247@item @var{result} @expansion{}
14248@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
14249
14250@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
14251@code{ @var{string} }
14252
14253@item @var{value} @expansion{}
14254@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
14255
14256@item @var{const} @expansion{}
14257@code{@var{c-string}}
14258
14259@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
14260@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
14261
14262@item @var{list} @expansion{}
14263@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
14264@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
14265
14266@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
14267@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
14268
14269@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
14270@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
14271
14272@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
14273@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
14274
14275@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
14276@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
14277
14278@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14279@code{CR | CR-LF}
14280
14281@item @var{token} @expansion{}
14282@emph{any sequence of digits}.
14283@end table
14284
14285@noindent
14286Notes:
14287
14288@itemize @bullet
14289@item
14290All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
14291
14292@item
14293The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
14294command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
14295@var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
14296original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
14297
14298@item
14299@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14300@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
14301progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
14302prefixed by @samp{+}.
14303
14304@item
14305@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14306@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
14307(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
14308@samp{*}.
14309
14310@item
14311@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14312@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
14313client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
14314output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
14315
14316@item
14317@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14318@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
14319console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
14320output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
14321
14322@item
14323@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14324@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
14325All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
14326
14327@item
14328@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14329@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
14330instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
14331the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
14332
14333@item
14334@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14335New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
14336@var{values}.
14337
14338
14339@end itemize
14340
14341@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
14342details about the various output records.
14343
14344@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
14345@subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
14346@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
14347
14348This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
14349the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
14350following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
14351the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
14352
14353@subsubheading Target Stop
14354@c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
14355Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
14356
14357@smallexample
14358-> -stop
14359<- (@value{GDBP})
14360@end smallexample
14361
14362@noindent
14363and later:
14364
14365@smallexample
14366<- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14367<- (@value{GDBP})
14368@end smallexample
14369
14370@subsubheading Simple CLI Command
14371
14372Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
14373@sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
14374
14375@smallexample
14376-> print 1+2
14377<- &"print 1+2\n"
14378<- ~"$1 = 3\n"
14379<- ^done
14380<- (@value{GDBP})
14381@end smallexample
14382
14383@subsubheading Command With Side Effects
14384
14385@smallexample
14386-> -symbol-file xyz.exe
14387<- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14388<- (@value{GDBP})
14389@end smallexample
14390
14391@subsubheading A Bad Command
14392
14393Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
14394
14395@smallexample
14396-> -rubbish
14397<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
14398<- (@value{GDBP})
14399@end smallexample
14400
14401@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14402@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
14403@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
14404
14405@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
14406@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
14407To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
14408accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
14409commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
14410respond.
14411
14412This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
14413clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
14414is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
14415behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
14416an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
14417
14418@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14419@node GDB/MI Output Records
14420@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
14421
14422@menu
14423* GDB/MI Result Records::
14424* GDB/MI Stream Records::
14425* GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
14426@end menu
14427
14428@node GDB/MI Result Records
14429@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
14430
14431@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14432@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
14433In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
14434@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
14435
14436@table @code
14437@findex ^done
14438@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
14439The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
14440values.
14441
14442@item "^running"
14443@findex ^running
14444@c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
14445The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
14446running.
14447
14448@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
14449@findex ^error
14450The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
14451error message.
14452@end table
14453
14454@node GDB/MI Stream Records
14455@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
14456
14457@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
14458@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14459@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
14460target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
14461funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
14462
14463Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
14464identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
14465Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
14466@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
14467line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
14468
14469@table @code
14470@item "~" @var{string-output}
14471The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
14472CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
14473
14474@item "@@" @var{string-output}
14475The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
14476target.
14477
14478@item "&" @var{string-output}
14479The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
14480internals.
14481@end table
14482
14483@node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
14484@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
14485
14486@cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14487@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
14488@dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
14489additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
14490consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
14491target activity (e.g., target stopped).
14492
14493The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
14494
14495@table @code
14496@item "*" "stop"
14497@end table
14498
14499
14500@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14501@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
14502@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
14503
14504The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
14505commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
14506
14507Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
14508readability. They don't appear in the real output.
14509Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
14510not yet implemented.
14511
14512@subheading Motivation
14513
14514The motivation for this collection of commands.
14515
14516@subheading Introduction
14517
14518A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
14519
14520@subheading Commands
14521
14522For each command in the block, the following is described:
14523
14524@subsubheading Synopsis
14525
14526@smallexample
14527 -command @var{args}@dots{}
14528@end smallexample
14529
14530@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14531
14532The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14533
14534@subsubheading Result
14535
14536@subsubheading Out-of-band
14537
14538@subsubheading Notes
14539
14540@subsubheading Example
14541
14542
14543@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14544@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
14545@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
14546
14547@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
14548@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
14549This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
14550breakpoints.
14551
14552@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
14553@findex -break-after
14554
14555@subsubheading Synopsis
14556
14557@smallexample
14558 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
14559@end smallexample
14560
14561The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
14562hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
14563the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
14564@samp{-break-list} command below.
14565
14566@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14567
14568The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
14569
14570@subsubheading Example
14571
14572@smallexample
14573(@value{GDBP})
14574-break-insert main
14575^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
14576(@value{GDBP})
14577-break-after 1 3
14578~
14579^done
14580(@value{GDBP})
14581-break-list
14582^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14583hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14584@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14585@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14586@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14587@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14588@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14589body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14590addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
14591ignore="3"@}]@}
14592(@value{GDBP})
14593@end smallexample
14594
14595@ignore
14596@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
14597@findex -break-catch
14598
14599@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
14600@findex -break-commands
14601@end ignore
14602
14603
14604@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
14605@findex -break-condition
14606
14607@subsubheading Synopsis
14608
14609@smallexample
14610 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
14611@end smallexample
14612
14613Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
14614@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
14615@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
14616command below).
14617
14618@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14619
14620The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
14621
14622@subsubheading Example
14623
14624@smallexample
14625(@value{GDBP})
14626-break-condition 1 1
14627^done
14628(@value{GDBP})
14629-break-list
14630^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14631hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14632@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14633@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14634@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14635@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14636@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14637body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14638addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
14639times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
14640(@value{GDBP})
14641@end smallexample
14642
14643@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
14644@findex -break-delete
14645
14646@subsubheading Synopsis
14647
14648@smallexample
14649 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14650@end smallexample
14651
14652Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
14653list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
14654
14655@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14656
14657The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
14658
14659@subsubheading Example
14660
14661@smallexample
14662(@value{GDBP})
14663-break-delete 1
14664^done
14665(@value{GDBP})
14666-break-list
14667^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14668hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14669@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14670@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14671@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14672@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14673@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14674body=[]@}
14675(@value{GDBP})
14676@end smallexample
14677
14678@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
14679@findex -break-disable
14680
14681@subsubheading Synopsis
14682
14683@smallexample
14684 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14685@end smallexample
14686
14687Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
14688break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
14689
14690@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14691
14692The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
14693
14694@subsubheading Example
14695
14696@smallexample
14697(@value{GDBP})
14698-break-disable 2
14699^done
14700(@value{GDBP})
14701-break-list
14702^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14703hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14704@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14705@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14706@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14707@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14708@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14709body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
14710addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14711(@value{GDBP})
14712@end smallexample
14713
14714@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
14715@findex -break-enable
14716
14717@subsubheading Synopsis
14718
14719@smallexample
14720 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14721@end smallexample
14722
14723Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
14724
14725@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14726
14727The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
14728
14729@subsubheading Example
14730
14731@smallexample
14732(@value{GDBP})
14733-break-enable 2
14734^done
14735(@value{GDBP})
14736-break-list
14737^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14738hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14739@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14740@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14741@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14742@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14743@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14744body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14745addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14746(@value{GDBP})
14747@end smallexample
14748
14749@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
14750@findex -break-info
14751
14752@subsubheading Synopsis
14753
14754@smallexample
14755 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
14756@end smallexample
14757
14758@c REDUNDANT???
14759Get information about a single breakpoint.
14760
14761@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14762
14763The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
14764
14765@subsubheading Example
14766N.A.
14767
14768@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
14769@findex -break-insert
14770
14771@subsubheading Synopsis
14772
14773@smallexample
14774 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
14775 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
14776 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
14777@end smallexample
14778
14779@noindent
14780If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
14781
14782@itemize @bullet
14783@item function
14784@c @item +offset
14785@c @item -offset
14786@c @item linenum
14787@item filename:linenum
14788@item filename:function
14789@item *address
14790@end itemize
14791
14792The possible optional parameters of this command are:
14793
14794@table @samp
14795@item -t
14796Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
14797@item -h
14798Insert a hardware breakpoint.
14799@item -c @var{condition}
14800Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
14801@item -i @var{ignore-count}
14802Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
14803@item -r
14804Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
14805given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
14806expresson.
14807@end table
14808
14809@subsubheading Result
14810
14811The result is in the form:
14812
14813@smallexample
14814 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
14815 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
14816@end smallexample
14817
14818@noindent
14819where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
14820is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
14821@var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
14822function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
14823
14824Note: this format is open to change.
14825@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
14826
14827@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14828
14829The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
14830@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
14831
14832@subsubheading Example
14833
14834@smallexample
14835(@value{GDBP})
14836-break-insert main
14837^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
14838(@value{GDBP})
14839-break-insert -t foo
14840^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
14841(@value{GDBP})
14842-break-list
14843^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
14844hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14845@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14846@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14847@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14848@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14849@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14850body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14851addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
14852bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
14853addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
14854(@value{GDBP})
14855-break-insert -r foo.*
14856~int foo(int, int);
14857^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
14858(@value{GDBP})
14859@end smallexample
14860
14861@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
14862@findex -break-list
14863
14864@subsubheading Synopsis
14865
14866@smallexample
14867 -break-list
14868@end smallexample
14869
14870Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
14871
14872@table @samp
14873@item Number
14874number of the breakpoint
14875@item Type
14876type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
14877@item Disposition
14878should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
14879or @samp{nokeep}
14880@item Enabled
14881is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
14882@item Address
14883memory location at which the breakpoint is set
14884@item What
14885logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
14886name, line number
14887@item Times
14888number of times the breakpoint has been hit
14889@end table
14890
14891If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
14892@code{body} field is an empty list.
14893
14894@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14895
14896The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
14897
14898@subsubheading Example
14899
14900@smallexample
14901(@value{GDBP})
14902-break-list
14903^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
14904hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14905@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14906@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14907@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14908@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14909@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14910body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14911addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
14912bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14913addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
14914(@value{GDBP})
14915@end smallexample
14916
14917Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
14918
14919@smallexample
14920(@value{GDBP})
14921-break-list
14922^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14923hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14924@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14925@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14926@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14927@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14928@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14929body=[]@}
14930(@value{GDBP})
14931@end smallexample
14932
14933@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
14934@findex -break-watch
14935
14936@subsubheading Synopsis
14937
14938@smallexample
14939 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
14940@end smallexample
14941
14942Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
14943@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
14944read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
14945option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
14946trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
14947either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
14948i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
14949@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
14950
14951Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
14952breakpoints inserted.
14953
14954@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14955
14956The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
14957@samp{rwatch}.
14958
14959@subsubheading Example
14960
14961Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
14962
14963@smallexample
14964(@value{GDBP})
14965-break-watch x
14966^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
14967(@value{GDBP})
14968-exec-continue
14969^running
14970^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
14971value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
14972frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="5"@}
14973(@value{GDBP})
14974@end smallexample
14975
14976Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
14977the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
14978for the watchpoint going out of scope.
14979
14980@smallexample
14981(@value{GDBP})
14982-break-watch C
14983^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
14984(@value{GDBP})
14985-exec-continue
14986^running
14987^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
14988wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
14989frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
14990file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
14991(@value{GDBP})
14992-exec-continue
14993^running
14994^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
14995frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
14996value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
14997file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
14998(@value{GDBP})
14999@end smallexample
15000
15001Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
15002execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
15003deleted.
15004
15005@smallexample
15006(@value{GDBP})
15007-break-watch C
15008^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
15009(@value{GDBP})
15010-break-list
15011^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15012hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15013@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15014@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15015@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15016@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15017@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15018body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15019addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15020file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15021bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15022enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
15023(@value{GDBP})
15024-exec-continue
15025^running
15026^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
15027value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15028frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15029file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15030(@value{GDBP})
15031-break-list
15032^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15033hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15034@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15035@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15036@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15037@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15038@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15039body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15040addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15041file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15042bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15043enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
15044(@value{GDBP})
15045-exec-continue
15046^running
15047^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
15048frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15049value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15050file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15051(@value{GDBP})
15052-break-list
15053^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15054hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15055@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15056@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15057@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15058@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15059@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15060body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15061addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15062file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
15063(@value{GDBP})
15064@end smallexample
15065
15066@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15067@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
15068@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
15069
15070@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
15071@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
15072This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
15073examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
15074
15075@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
15076@c @subheading -data-assign
15077@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
15078@c @subsubheading GDB command
15079@c set variable
15080@c @subsubheading Example
15081@c N.A.
15082
15083@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
15084@findex -data-disassemble
15085
15086@subsubheading Synopsis
15087
15088@smallexample
15089 -data-disassemble
15090 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
15091 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
15092 -- @var{mode}
15093@end smallexample
15094
15095@noindent
15096Where:
15097
15098@table @samp
15099@item @var{start-addr}
15100is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
15101@item @var{end-addr}
15102is the end address
15103@item @var{filename}
15104is the name of the file to disassemble
15105@item @var{linenum}
15106is the line number to disassemble around
15107@item @var{lines}
15108is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
15109the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
15110specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
15111@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
15112@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
15113displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
15114@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
15115are displayed.
15116@item @var{mode}
15117is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
15118disassembly).
15119@end table
15120
15121@subsubheading Result
15122
15123The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
15124
15125@itemize @bullet
15126@item Address
15127@item Func-name
15128@item Offset
15129@item Instruction
15130@end itemize
15131
15132Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
15133directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
15134
15135@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15136
15137There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
15138
15139@subsubheading Example
15140
15141Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
15142
15143@smallexample
15144(@value{GDBP})
15145-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
15146^done,
15147asm_insns=[
15148@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15149inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15150@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15151inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15152@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
15153inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
15154@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
15155inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15156@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
15157inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
15158(@value{GDBP})
15159@end smallexample
15160
15161Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
15162@code{main}.
15163
15164@smallexample
15165-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
15166^done,asm_insns=[
15167@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15168inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15169@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15170inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15171@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15172inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15173[@dots{}]
15174@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
15175@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
15176(@value{GDBP})
15177@end smallexample
15178
15179Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
15180
15181@smallexample
15182(@value{GDBP})
15183-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
15184^done,asm_insns=[
15185@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15186inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15187@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15188inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15189@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15190inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
15191(@value{GDBP})
15192@end smallexample
15193
15194Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
15195
15196@smallexample
15197(@value{GDBP})
15198-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
15199^done,asm_insns=[
15200src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
15201file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15202 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15203@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15204inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
15205src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
15206file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15207 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15208@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15209inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15210@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15211inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
15212(@value{GDBP})
15213@end smallexample
15214
15215
15216@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
15217@findex -data-evaluate-expression
15218
15219@subsubheading Synopsis
15220
15221@smallexample
15222 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
15223@end smallexample
15224
15225Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
15226inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
15227If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
15228
15229@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15230
15231The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
15232@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
15233@samp{gdb_eval} command.
15234
15235@subsubheading Example
15236
15237In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
15238@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
15239Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
15240output.
15241
15242@smallexample
15243211-data-evaluate-expression A
15244211^done,value="1"
15245(@value{GDBP})
15246311-data-evaluate-expression &A
15247311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
15248(@value{GDBP})
15249411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
15250411^done,value="4"
15251(@value{GDBP})
15252511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
15253511^done,value="4"
15254(@value{GDBP})
15255@end smallexample
15256
15257
15258@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
15259@findex -data-list-changed-registers
15260
15261@subsubheading Synopsis
15262
15263@smallexample
15264 -data-list-changed-registers
15265@end smallexample
15266
15267Display a list of the registers that have changed.
15268
15269@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15270
15271@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
15272has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
15273
15274@subsubheading Example
15275
15276On a PPC MBX board:
15277
15278@smallexample
15279(@value{GDBP})
15280-exec-continue
15281^running
15282
15283(@value{GDBP})
15284*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
15285args=[],file="try.c",line="5"@}
15286(@value{GDBP})
15287-data-list-changed-registers
15288^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
15289"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
15290"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
15291(@value{GDBP})
15292@end smallexample
15293
15294
15295@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
15296@findex -data-list-register-names
15297
15298@subsubheading Synopsis
15299
15300@smallexample
15301 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
15302@end smallexample
15303
15304Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
15305are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
15306integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
15307names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
15308consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
15309include empty register names.
15310
15311@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15312
15313@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
15314@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
15315corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
15316
15317@subsubheading Example
15318
15319For the PPC MBX board:
15320@smallexample
15321(@value{GDBP})
15322-data-list-register-names
15323^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
15324"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
15325"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
15326"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
15327"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
15328"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
15329"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
15330(@value{GDBP})
15331-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
15332^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
15333(@value{GDBP})
15334@end smallexample
15335
15336@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
15337@findex -data-list-register-values
15338
15339@subsubheading Synopsis
15340
15341@smallexample
15342 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
15343@end smallexample
15344
15345Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
15346which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
15347list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
15348numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
15349
15350Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
15351
15352@table @code
15353@item x
15354Hexadecimal
15355@item o
15356Octal
15357@item t
15358Binary
15359@item d
15360Decimal
15361@item r
15362Raw
15363@item N
15364Natural
15365@end table
15366
15367@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15368
15369The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
15370all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
15371
15372@subsubheading Example
15373
15374For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
15375don't appear in the actual output):
15376
15377@smallexample
15378(@value{GDBP})
15379-data-list-register-values r 64 65
15380^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15381@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
15382(@value{GDBP})
15383-data-list-register-values x
15384^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
15385@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15386@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
15387@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
15388@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
15389@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
15390@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
15391@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
15392@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
15393@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15394@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
15395@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
15396@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
15397@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
15398@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
15399@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
15400@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
15401@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
15402@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
15403@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
15404@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
15405@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
15406@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
15407@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
15408@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
15409@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
15410@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
15411@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
15412@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
15413@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
15414@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
15415@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
15416@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15417@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
15418@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
15419@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
15420(@value{GDBP})
15421@end smallexample
15422
15423
15424@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
15425@findex -data-read-memory
15426
15427@subsubheading Synopsis
15428
15429@smallexample
15430 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
15431 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
15432 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
15433@end smallexample
15434
15435@noindent
15436where:
15437
15438@table @samp
15439@item @var{address}
15440An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
15441read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
15442quoted using the C convention.
15443
15444@item @var{word-format}
15445The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
15446same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
15447,Output formats}).
15448
15449@item @var{word-size}
15450The size of each memory word in bytes.
15451
15452@item @var{nr-rows}
15453The number of rows in the output table.
15454
15455@item @var{nr-cols}
15456The number of columns in the output table.
15457
15458@item @var{aschar}
15459If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
15460value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
15461member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
15462characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
15463
15464@item @var{byte-offset}
15465An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
15466@end table
15467
15468This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
15469@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
15470@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
15471(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
15472of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
15473using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
15474in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
15475@samp{addr}.
15476
15477The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
15478@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
15479@samp{prev-page}.
15480
15481@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15482
15483The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
15484@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
15485
15486@subsubheading Example
15487
15488Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
15489@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
15490word. Display each word in hex.
15491
15492@smallexample
15493(@value{GDBP})
154949-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
154959^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
15496next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
15497prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
15498@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
15499@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
15500@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
15501(@value{GDBP})
15502@end smallexample
15503
15504Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
15505display as a single word formatted in decimal.
15506
15507@smallexample
15508(@value{GDBP})
155095-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
155105^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
15511next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
15512next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
15513@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
15514(@value{GDBP})
15515@end smallexample
15516
15517Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
15518as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
15519used as the non-printable character.
15520
15521@smallexample
15522(@value{GDBP})
155234-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
155244^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
15525next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
15526next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
15527@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15528@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15529@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15530@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15531@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
15532@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
15533@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
15534@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
15535(@value{GDBP})
15536@end smallexample
15537
15538@subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
15539@findex -display-delete
15540
15541@subsubheading Synopsis
15542
15543@smallexample
15544 -display-delete @var{number}
15545@end smallexample
15546
15547Delete the display @var{number}.
15548
15549@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15550
15551The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
15552
15553@subsubheading Example
15554N.A.
15555
15556
15557@subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
15558@findex -display-disable
15559
15560@subsubheading Synopsis
15561
15562@smallexample
15563 -display-disable @var{number}
15564@end smallexample
15565
15566Disable display @var{number}.
15567
15568@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15569
15570The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
15571
15572@subsubheading Example
15573N.A.
15574
15575
15576@subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
15577@findex -display-enable
15578
15579@subsubheading Synopsis
15580
15581@smallexample
15582 -display-enable @var{number}
15583@end smallexample
15584
15585Enable display @var{number}.
15586
15587@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15588
15589The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
15590
15591@subsubheading Example
15592N.A.
15593
15594
15595@subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
15596@findex -display-insert
15597
15598@subsubheading Synopsis
15599
15600@smallexample
15601 -display-insert @var{expression}
15602@end smallexample
15603
15604Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
15605
15606@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15607
15608The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
15609
15610@subsubheading Example
15611N.A.
15612
15613
15614@subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
15615@findex -display-list
15616
15617@subsubheading Synopsis
15618
15619@smallexample
15620 -display-list
15621@end smallexample
15622
15623List the displays. Do not show the current values.
15624
15625@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15626
15627The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
15628
15629@subsubheading Example
15630N.A.
15631
15632
15633@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
15634@findex -environment-cd
15635
15636@subsubheading Synopsis
15637
15638@smallexample
15639 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
15640@end smallexample
15641
15642Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
15643
15644@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15645
15646The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
15647
15648@subsubheading Example
15649
15650@smallexample
15651(@value{GDBP})
15652-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15653^done
15654(@value{GDBP})
15655@end smallexample
15656
15657
15658@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
15659@findex -environment-directory
15660
15661@subsubheading Synopsis
15662
15663@smallexample
15664 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15665@end smallexample
15666
15667Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
15668If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
15669search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
15670@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15671occurs as normal.
15672Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15673multiple directories in a single command
15674results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15675search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15676If blanks are needed as
15677part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15678the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15679by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15680character must not be used
15681in any directory name.
15682If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
15683
15684@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15685
15686The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
15687
15688@subsubheading Example
15689
15690@smallexample
15691(@value{GDBP})
15692-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15693^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15694(@value{GDBP})
15695-environment-directory ""
15696^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15697(@value{GDBP})
15698-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
15699^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
15700(@value{GDBP})
15701-environment-directory -r
15702^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
15703(@value{GDBP})
15704@end smallexample
15705
15706
15707@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
15708@findex -environment-path
15709
15710@subsubheading Synopsis
15711
15712@smallexample
15713 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15714@end smallexample
15715
15716Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
15717If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
15718search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
15719supplied in addition to the
15720@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15721occurs as normal.
15722Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15723multiple directories in a single command
15724results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15725search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15726If blanks are needed as
15727part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15728the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15729by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15730character must not be used
15731in any directory name.
15732If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
15733
15734
15735@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15736
15737The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
15738
15739@subsubheading Example
15740
15741@smallexample
15742(@value{GDBP})
15743-environment-path
15744^done,path="/usr/bin"
15745(@value{GDBP})
15746-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
15747^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
15748(@value{GDBP})
15749-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
15750^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
15751(@value{GDBP})
15752@end smallexample
15753
15754
15755@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
15756@findex -environment-pwd
15757
15758@subsubheading Synopsis
15759
15760@smallexample
15761 -environment-pwd
15762@end smallexample
15763
15764Show the current working directory.
15765
15766@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15767
15768The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
15769
15770@subsubheading Example
15771
15772@smallexample
15773(@value{GDBP})
15774-environment-pwd
15775^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
15776(@value{GDBP})
15777@end smallexample
15778
15779@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15780@node GDB/MI Program Control
15781@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
15782
15783@subsubheading Program termination
15784
15785As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
15786it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
15787include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
15788
15789@subsubheading Examples
15790
15791@noindent
15792Program exited normally:
15793
15794@smallexample
15795(@value{GDBP})
15796-exec-run
15797^running
15798(@value{GDBP})
15799x = 55
15800*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
15801(@value{GDBP})
15802@end smallexample
15803
15804@noindent
15805Program exited exceptionally:
15806
15807@smallexample
15808(@value{GDBP})
15809-exec-run
15810^running
15811(@value{GDBP})
15812x = 55
15813*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
15814(@value{GDBP})
15815@end smallexample
15816
15817Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
15818@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
15819
15820@smallexample
15821(@value{GDBP})
15822*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
15823signal-meaning="Interrupt"
15824@end smallexample
15825
15826
15827@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
15828@findex -exec-abort
15829
15830@subsubheading Synopsis
15831
15832@smallexample
15833 -exec-abort
15834@end smallexample
15835
15836Kill the inferior running program.
15837
15838@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15839
15840The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
15841
15842@subsubheading Example
15843N.A.
15844
15845
15846@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
15847@findex -exec-arguments
15848
15849@subsubheading Synopsis
15850
15851@smallexample
15852 -exec-arguments @var{args}
15853@end smallexample
15854
15855Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
15856@samp{-exec-run}.
15857
15858@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15859
15860The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
15861
15862@subsubheading Example
15863
15864@c FIXME!
15865Don't have one around.
15866
15867
15868@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
15869@findex -exec-continue
15870
15871@subsubheading Synopsis
15872
15873@smallexample
15874 -exec-continue
15875@end smallexample
15876
15877Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
15878until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
15879
15880@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15881
15882The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
15883
15884@subsubheading Example
15885
15886@smallexample
15887-exec-continue
15888^running
15889(@value{GDBP})
15890@@Hello world
15891*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
15892file="hello.c",line="13"@}
15893(@value{GDBP})
15894@end smallexample
15895
15896
15897@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
15898@findex -exec-finish
15899
15900@subsubheading Synopsis
15901
15902@smallexample
15903 -exec-finish
15904@end smallexample
15905
15906Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
15907until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
15908the function.
15909
15910@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15911
15912The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
15913
15914@subsubheading Example
15915
15916Function returning @code{void}.
15917
15918@smallexample
15919-exec-finish
15920^running
15921(@value{GDBP})
15922@@hello from foo
15923*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
15924file="hello.c",line="7"@}
15925(@value{GDBP})
15926@end smallexample
15927
15928Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
15929@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
15930value itself.
15931
15932@smallexample
15933-exec-finish
15934^running
15935(@value{GDBP})
15936*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
15937args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
15938file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
15939gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
15940(@value{GDBP})
15941@end smallexample
15942
15943
15944@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
15945@findex -exec-interrupt
15946
15947@subsubheading Synopsis
15948
15949@smallexample
15950 -exec-interrupt
15951@end smallexample
15952
15953Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
15954Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
15955execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
15956itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
15957interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
15958
15959@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15960
15961The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
15962
15963@subsubheading Example
15964
15965@smallexample
15966(@value{GDBP})
15967111-exec-continue
15968111^running
15969
15970(@value{GDBP})
15971222-exec-interrupt
15972222^done
15973(@value{GDBP})
15974111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
15975frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="13"@}
15976(@value{GDBP})
15977
15978(@value{GDBP})
15979-exec-interrupt
15980^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
15981(@value{GDBP})
15982@end smallexample
15983
15984
15985@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
15986@findex -exec-next
15987
15988@subsubheading Synopsis
15989
15990@smallexample
15991 -exec-next
15992@end smallexample
15993
15994Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
15995when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
15996
15997@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15998
15999The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
16000
16001@subsubheading Example
16002
16003@smallexample
16004-exec-next
16005^running
16006(@value{GDBP})
16007*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
16008(@value{GDBP})
16009@end smallexample
16010
16011
16012@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
16013@findex -exec-next-instruction
16014
16015@subsubheading Synopsis
16016
16017@smallexample
16018 -exec-next-instruction
16019@end smallexample
16020
16021Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
16022instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
16023the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
16024address will be printed as well.
16025
16026@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16027
16028The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
16029
16030@subsubheading Example
16031
16032@smallexample
16033(@value{GDBP})
16034-exec-next-instruction
16035^running
16036
16037(@value{GDBP})
16038*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16039addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
16040(@value{GDBP})
16041@end smallexample
16042
16043
16044@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
16045@findex -exec-return
16046
16047@subsubheading Synopsis
16048
16049@smallexample
16050 -exec-return
16051@end smallexample
16052
16053Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
16054Displays the new current frame.
16055
16056@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16057
16058The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
16059
16060@subsubheading Example
16061
16062@smallexample
16063(@value{GDBP})
16064200-break-insert callee4
16065200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
16066file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16067(@value{GDBP})
16068000-exec-run
16069000^running
16070(@value{GDBP})
16071000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16072frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
16073file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16074(@value{GDBP})
16075205-break-delete
16076205^done
16077(@value{GDBP})
16078111-exec-return
16079111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
16080args=[@{name="strarg",
16081value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
16082file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
16083(@value{GDBP})
16084@end smallexample
16085
16086
16087@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
16088@findex -exec-run
16089
16090@subsubheading Synopsis
16091
16092@smallexample
16093 -exec-run
16094@end smallexample
16095
16096Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
16097beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
16098encountered or the program exits.
16099
16100@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16101
16102The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
16103
16104@subsubheading Example
16105
16106@smallexample
16107(@value{GDBP})
16108-break-insert main
16109^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16110(@value{GDBP})
16111-exec-run
16112^running
16113(@value{GDBP})
16114*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16115frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16116(@value{GDBP})
16117@end smallexample
16118
16119
16120@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
16121@findex -exec-show-arguments
16122
16123@subsubheading Synopsis
16124
16125@smallexample
16126 -exec-show-arguments
16127@end smallexample
16128
16129Print the arguments of the program.
16130
16131@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16132
16133The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
16134
16135@subsubheading Example
16136N.A.
16137
16138@c @subheading -exec-signal
16139
16140@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
16141@findex -exec-step
16142
16143@subsubheading Synopsis
16144
16145@smallexample
16146 -exec-step
16147@end smallexample
16148
16149Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16150when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
16151source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
16152instruction of the called function.
16153
16154@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16155
16156The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
16157
16158@subsubheading Example
16159
16160Stepping into a function:
16161
16162@smallexample
16163-exec-step
16164^running
16165(@value{GDBP})
16166*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16167frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
16168@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
16169(@value{GDBP})
16170@end smallexample
16171
16172Regular stepping:
16173
16174@smallexample
16175-exec-step
16176^running
16177(@value{GDBP})
16178*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
16179(@value{GDBP})
16180@end smallexample
16181
16182
16183@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
16184@findex -exec-step-instruction
16185
16186@subsubheading Synopsis
16187
16188@smallexample
16189 -exec-step-instruction
16190@end smallexample
16191
16192Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
16193instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
16194whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
16195former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
16196well.
16197
16198@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16199
16200The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
16201
16202@subsubheading Example
16203
16204@smallexample
16205(@value{GDBP})
16206-exec-step-instruction
16207^running
16208
16209(@value{GDBP})
16210*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16211frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16212(@value{GDBP})
16213-exec-step-instruction
16214^running
16215
16216(@value{GDBP})
16217*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16218frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16219(@value{GDBP})
16220@end smallexample
16221
16222
16223@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
16224@findex -exec-until
16225
16226@subsubheading Synopsis
16227
16228@smallexample
16229 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
16230@end smallexample
16231
16232Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
16233specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
16234executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
16235The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
16236
16237@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16238
16239The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
16240
16241@subsubheading Example
16242
16243@smallexample
16244(@value{GDBP})
16245-exec-until recursive2.c:6
16246^running
16247(@value{GDBP})
16248x = 55
16249*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16250file="recursive2.c",line="6"@}
16251(@value{GDBP})
16252@end smallexample
16253
16254@ignore
16255@subheading -file-clear
16256Is this going away????
16257@end ignore
16258
16259
16260@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
16261@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
16262
16263@subsubheading Synopsis
16264
16265@smallexample
16266 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
16267@end smallexample
16268
16269Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
16270which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
16271command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
16272are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
16273error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
16274notification.
16275
16276@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16277
16278The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
16279
16280@subsubheading Example
16281
16282@smallexample
16283(@value{GDBP})
16284-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16285^done
16286(@value{GDBP})
16287@end smallexample
16288
16289
16290@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
16291@findex -file-exec-file
16292
16293@subsubheading Synopsis
16294
16295@smallexample
16296 -file-exec-file @var{file}
16297@end smallexample
16298
16299Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
16300@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
16301from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
16302about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
16303notification.
16304
16305@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16306
16307The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
16308
16309@subsubheading Example
16310
16311@smallexample
16312(@value{GDBP})
16313-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16314^done
16315(@value{GDBP})
16316@end smallexample
16317
16318
16319@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
16320@findex -file-list-exec-sections
16321
16322@subsubheading Synopsis
16323
16324@smallexample
16325 -file-list-exec-sections
16326@end smallexample
16327
16328List the sections of the current executable file.
16329
16330@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16331
16332The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
16333information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
16334@samp{gdb_load_info}.
16335
16336@subsubheading Example
16337N.A.
16338
16339
16340@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
16341@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
16342
16343@subsubheading Synopsis
16344
16345@smallexample
16346 -file-list-exec-source-files
16347@end smallexample
16348
16349List the source files for the current executable.
16350
16351@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16352
16353There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16354@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
16355
16356@subsubheading Example
16357N.A.
16358
16359
16360@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
16361@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
16362
16363@subsubheading Synopsis
16364
16365@smallexample
16366 -file-list-shared-libraries
16367@end smallexample
16368
16369List the shared libraries in the program.
16370
16371@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16372
16373The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
16374
16375@subsubheading Example
16376N.A.
16377
16378
16379@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
16380@findex -file-list-symbol-files
16381
16382@subsubheading Synopsis
16383
16384@smallexample
16385 -file-list-symbol-files
16386@end smallexample
16387
16388List symbol files.
16389
16390@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16391
16392The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
16393
16394@subsubheading Example
16395N.A.
16396
16397
16398@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
16399@findex -file-symbol-file
16400
16401@subsubheading Synopsis
16402
16403@smallexample
16404 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
16405@end smallexample
16406
16407Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
16408used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
16409produced, except for a completion notification.
16410
16411@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16412
16413The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
16414
16415@subsubheading Example
16416
16417@smallexample
16418(@value{GDBP})
16419-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16420^done
16421(@value{GDBP})
16422@end smallexample
16423
16424@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16425@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
16426@section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
16427
16428@c @subheading -gdb-complete
16429
16430@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
16431@findex -gdb-exit
16432
16433@subsubheading Synopsis
16434
16435@smallexample
16436 -gdb-exit
16437@end smallexample
16438
16439Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
16440
16441@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16442
16443Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
16444
16445@subsubheading Example
16446
16447@smallexample
16448(@value{GDBP})
16449-gdb-exit
16450@end smallexample
16451
16452@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
16453@findex -gdb-set
16454
16455@subsubheading Synopsis
16456
16457@smallexample
16458 -gdb-set
16459@end smallexample
16460
16461Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
16462@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
16463
16464@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16465
16466The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
16467
16468@subsubheading Example
16469
16470@smallexample
16471(@value{GDBP})
16472-gdb-set $foo=3
16473^done
16474(@value{GDBP})
16475@end smallexample
16476
16477
16478@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
16479@findex -gdb-show
16480
16481@subsubheading Synopsis
16482
16483@smallexample
16484 -gdb-show
16485@end smallexample
16486
16487Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
16488
16489@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16490
16491The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
16492
16493@subsubheading Example
16494
16495@smallexample
16496(@value{GDBP})
16497-gdb-show annotate
16498^done,value="0"
16499(@value{GDBP})
16500@end smallexample
16501
16502@c @subheading -gdb-source
16503
16504
16505@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
16506@findex -gdb-version
16507
16508@subsubheading Synopsis
16509
16510@smallexample
16511 -gdb-version
16512@end smallexample
16513
16514Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
16515
16516@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16517
16518There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
16519information when you start an interactive session.
16520
16521@subsubheading Example
16522
16523@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
16524@c box in TeX.
16525@smallexample
16526(@value{GDBP})
16527-gdb-version
16528~GNU gdb 5.2.1
16529~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
16530~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
16531~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
16532~ certain conditions.
16533~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
16534~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
16535~ details.
16536~This GDB was configured as
16537 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
16538^done
16539(@value{GDBP})
16540@end smallexample
16541
16542@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
16543@findex -interpreter-exec
16544
16545@subheading Synopsis
16546
16547@smallexample
16548-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
16549@end smallexample
16550
16551Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
16552
16553@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
16554
16555The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
16556
16557@subheading Example
16558
16559@smallexample
16560(@value{GDBP})
16561-interpreter-exec console "break main"
16562&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
16563&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
16564~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
16565^done
16566(@value{GDBP})
16567@end smallexample
16568
16569@ignore
16570@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16571@node GDB/MI Kod Commands
16572@section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
16573
16574The Kod commands are not implemented.
16575
16576@c @subheading -kod-info
16577
16578@c @subheading -kod-list
16579
16580@c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
16581
16582@c @subheading -kod-show
16583
16584@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16585@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
16586@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
16587
16588The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
16589
16590@c @subheading -overlay-auto
16591
16592@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
16593
16594@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
16595
16596@c @subheading -overlay-map
16597
16598@c @subheading -overlay-off
16599
16600@c @subheading -overlay-on
16601
16602@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
16603
16604@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16605@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
16606@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
16607
16608Signal handling commands are not implemented.
16609
16610@c @subheading -signal-handle
16611
16612@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
16613
16614@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
16615@end ignore
16616
16617
16618@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16619@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
16620@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
16621
16622
16623@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
16624@findex -stack-info-frame
16625
16626@subsubheading Synopsis
16627
16628@smallexample
16629 -stack-info-frame
16630@end smallexample
16631
16632Get info on the current frame.
16633
16634@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16635
16636The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
16637(without arguments).
16638
16639@subsubheading Example
16640N.A.
16641
16642@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
16643@findex -stack-info-depth
16644
16645@subsubheading Synopsis
16646
16647@smallexample
16648 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
16649@end smallexample
16650
16651Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
16652is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
16653
16654@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16655
16656There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
16657
16658@subsubheading Example
16659
16660For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
16661
16662@smallexample
16663(@value{GDBP})
16664-stack-info-depth
16665^done,depth="12"
16666(@value{GDBP})
16667-stack-info-depth 4
16668^done,depth="4"
16669(@value{GDBP})
16670-stack-info-depth 12
16671^done,depth="12"
16672(@value{GDBP})
16673-stack-info-depth 11
16674^done,depth="11"
16675(@value{GDBP})
16676-stack-info-depth 13
16677^done,depth="12"
16678(@value{GDBP})
16679@end smallexample
16680
16681@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
16682@findex -stack-list-arguments
16683
16684@subsubheading Synopsis
16685
16686@smallexample
16687 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
16688 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16689@end smallexample
16690
16691Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
16692and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
16693@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
16694stack.
16695
16696The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
166970 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
16698means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
16699
16700@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16701
16702@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
16703@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
16704functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
16705
16706@subsubheading Example
16707
16708@smallexample
16709(@value{GDBP})
16710-stack-list-frames
16711^done,
16712stack=[
16713frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
16714file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
16715frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
16716file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
16717frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
16718file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
16719frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
16720file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
16721frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
16722file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
16723(@value{GDBP})
16724-stack-list-arguments 0
16725^done,
16726stack-args=[
16727frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16728frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
16729frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
16730frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
16731frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16732(@value{GDBP})
16733-stack-list-arguments 1
16734^done,
16735stack-args=[
16736frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16737frame=@{level="1",
16738 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16739frame=@{level="2",args=[
16740@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16741@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16742@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
16743@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16744@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
16745@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
16746frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16747(@value{GDBP})
16748-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
16749^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
16750(@value{GDBP})
16751-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
16752^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
16753args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16754@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
16755(@value{GDBP})
16756@end smallexample
16757
16758@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
16759
16760
16761@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
16762@findex -stack-list-frames
16763
16764@subsubheading Synopsis
16765
16766@smallexample
16767 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16768@end smallexample
16769
16770List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
16771following info:
16772
16773@table @samp
16774@item @var{level}
16775The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
16776@item @var{addr}
16777The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
16778@item @var{func}
16779Function name.
16780@item @var{file}
16781File name of the source file where the function lives.
16782@item @var{line}
16783Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
16784@end table
16785
16786If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
16787whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
16788levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
16789are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
16790
16791@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16792
16793The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
16794
16795@subsubheading Example
16796
16797Full stack backtrace:
16798
16799@smallexample
16800(@value{GDBP})
16801-stack-list-frames
16802^done,stack=
16803[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
16804 file="recursive2.c",line="11"@},
16805frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16806 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16807frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16808 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16809frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16810 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16811frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16812 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16813frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16814 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16815frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16816 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16817frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16818 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16819frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16820 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16821frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16822 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16823frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16824 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16825frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
16826 file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
16827(@value{GDBP})
16828@end smallexample
16829
16830Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
16831
16832@smallexample
16833(@value{GDBP})
16834-stack-list-frames 3 5
16835^done,stack=
16836[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16837 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16838frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16839 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16840frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16841 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
16842(@value{GDBP})
16843@end smallexample
16844
16845Show a single frame:
16846
16847@smallexample
16848(@value{GDBP})
16849-stack-list-frames 3 3
16850^done,stack=
16851[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16852 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
16853(@value{GDBP})
16854@end smallexample
16855
16856
16857@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
16858@findex -stack-list-locals
16859
16860@subsubheading Synopsis
16861
16862@smallexample
16863 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
16864@end smallexample
16865
16866Display the local variable names for the current frame. With an
16867argument of 0 prints only the names of the variables, with argument of 1
16868prints also their values.
16869
16870@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16871
16872@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
16873
16874@subsubheading Example
16875
16876@smallexample
16877(@value{GDBP})
16878-stack-list-locals 0
16879^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
16880(@value{GDBP})
16881-stack-list-locals 1
16882^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
16883 @{name="C",value="3"@}]
16884(@value{GDBP})
16885@end smallexample
16886
16887
16888@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
16889@findex -stack-select-frame
16890
16891@subsubheading Synopsis
16892
16893@smallexample
16894 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
16895@end smallexample
16896
16897Change the current frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
16898the stack.
16899
16900@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16901
16902The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
16903@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
16904
16905@subsubheading Example
16906
16907@smallexample
16908(@value{GDBP})
16909-stack-select-frame 2
16910^done
16911(@value{GDBP})
16912@end smallexample
16913
16914@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16915@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
16916@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
16917
16918
16919@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
16920@findex -symbol-info-address
16921
16922@subsubheading Synopsis
16923
16924@smallexample
16925 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
16926@end smallexample
16927
16928Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
16929
16930@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16931
16932The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
16933
16934@subsubheading Example
16935N.A.
16936
16937
16938@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
16939@findex -symbol-info-file
16940
16941@subsubheading Synopsis
16942
16943@smallexample
16944 -symbol-info-file
16945@end smallexample
16946
16947Show the file for the symbol.
16948
16949@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16950
16951There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
16952@samp{gdb_find_file}.
16953
16954@subsubheading Example
16955N.A.
16956
16957
16958@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
16959@findex -symbol-info-function
16960
16961@subsubheading Synopsis
16962
16963@smallexample
16964 -symbol-info-function
16965@end smallexample
16966
16967Show which function the symbol lives in.
16968
16969@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16970
16971@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
16972
16973@subsubheading Example
16974N.A.
16975
16976
16977@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
16978@findex -symbol-info-line
16979
16980@subsubheading Synopsis
16981
16982@smallexample
16983 -symbol-info-line
16984@end smallexample
16985
16986Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
16987
16988@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16989
16990The corresponding @value{GDBN} comamnd is @samp{info line}.
16991@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
16992
16993@subsubheading Example
16994N.A.
16995
16996
16997@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
16998@findex -symbol-info-symbol
16999
17000@subsubheading Synopsis
17001
17002@smallexample
17003 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
17004@end smallexample
17005
17006Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
17007
17008@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17009
17010The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
17011
17012@subsubheading Example
17013N.A.
17014
17015
17016@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
17017@findex -symbol-list-functions
17018
17019@subsubheading Synopsis
17020
17021@smallexample
17022 -symbol-list-functions
17023@end smallexample
17024
17025List the functions in the executable.
17026
17027@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17028
17029@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
17030@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17031
17032@subsubheading Example
17033N.A.
17034
17035
17036@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
17037@findex -symbol-list-types
17038
17039@subsubheading Synopsis
17040
17041@smallexample
17042 -symbol-list-types
17043@end smallexample
17044
17045List all the type names.
17046
17047@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17048
17049The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
17050@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17051
17052@subsubheading Example
17053N.A.
17054
17055
17056@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
17057@findex -symbol-list-variables
17058
17059@subsubheading Synopsis
17060
17061@smallexample
17062 -symbol-list-variables
17063@end smallexample
17064
17065List all the global and static variable names.
17066
17067@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17068
17069@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17070
17071@subsubheading Example
17072N.A.
17073
17074
17075@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
17076@findex -symbol-locate
17077
17078@subsubheading Synopsis
17079
17080@smallexample
17081 -symbol-locate
17082@end smallexample
17083
17084@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17085
17086@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
17087
17088@subsubheading Example
17089N.A.
17090
17091
17092@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
17093@findex -symbol-type
17094
17095@subsubheading Synopsis
17096
17097@smallexample
17098 -symbol-type @var{variable}
17099@end smallexample
17100
17101Show type of @var{variable}.
17102
17103@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17104
17105The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
17106@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
17107
17108@subsubheading Example
17109N.A.
17110
17111
17112@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17113@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
17114@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
17115
17116
17117@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
17118@findex -target-attach
17119
17120@subsubheading Synopsis
17121
17122@smallexample
17123 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
17124@end smallexample
17125
17126Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
17127
17128@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17129
17130The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
17131
17132@subsubheading Example
17133N.A.
17134
17135
17136@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
17137@findex -target-compare-sections
17138
17139@subsubheading Synopsis
17140
17141@smallexample
17142 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
17143@end smallexample
17144
17145Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
17146Without the argument, all sections are compared.
17147
17148@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17149
17150The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
17151
17152@subsubheading Example
17153N.A.
17154
17155
17156@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
17157@findex -target-detach
17158
17159@subsubheading Synopsis
17160
17161@smallexample
17162 -target-detach
17163@end smallexample
17164
17165Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17166
17167@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17168
17169The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
17170
17171@subsubheading Example
17172
17173@smallexample
17174(@value{GDBP})
17175-target-detach
17176^done
17177(@value{GDBP})
17178@end smallexample
17179
17180
17181@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
17182@findex -target-download
17183
17184@subsubheading Synopsis
17185
17186@smallexample
17187 -target-download
17188@end smallexample
17189
17190Loads the executable onto the remote target.
17191It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
17192
17193@table @samp
17194@item section
17195The name of the section.
17196@item section-sent
17197The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
17198@item section-size
17199The size of the section.
17200@item total-sent
17201The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
17202@item total-size
17203The size of the overall executable to download.
17204@end table
17205
17206@noindent
17207Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
17208@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
17209
17210In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
17211downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
17212
17213@table @samp
17214@item section
17215The name of the section.
17216@item section-size
17217The size of the section.
17218@item total-size
17219The size of the overall executable to download.
17220@end table
17221
17222@noindent
17223At the end, a summary is printed.
17224
17225@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17226
17227The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
17228
17229@subsubheading Example
17230
17231Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
17232have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
17233
17234@smallexample
17235(@value{GDBP})
17236-target-download
17237+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
17238+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
17239total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
17240+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
17241total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
17242+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
17243total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
17244+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
17245total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
17246+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
17247total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
17248+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
17249total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
17250+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
17251total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
17252+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
17253total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
17254+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
17255total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
17256+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
17257total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
17258+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
17259total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
17260+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
17261total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
17262+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
17263total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
17264+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17265+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17266+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
17267+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
17268total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
17269+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
17270total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
17271+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
17272total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
17273+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
17274total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
17275+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
17276total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
17277+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
17278total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
17279^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
17280write-rate="429"
17281(@value{GDBP})
17282@end smallexample
17283
17284
17285@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
17286@findex -target-exec-status
17287
17288@subsubheading Synopsis
17289
17290@smallexample
17291 -target-exec-status
17292@end smallexample
17293
17294Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
17295not, for instance).
17296
17297@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17298
17299There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17300
17301@subsubheading Example
17302N.A.
17303
17304
17305@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
17306@findex -target-list-available-targets
17307
17308@subsubheading Synopsis
17309
17310@smallexample
17311 -target-list-available-targets
17312@end smallexample
17313
17314List the possible targets to connect to.
17315
17316@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17317
17318The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
17319
17320@subsubheading Example
17321N.A.
17322
17323
17324@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
17325@findex -target-list-current-targets
17326
17327@subsubheading Synopsis
17328
17329@smallexample
17330 -target-list-current-targets
17331@end smallexample
17332
17333Describe the current target.
17334
17335@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17336
17337The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
17338other things).
17339
17340@subsubheading Example
17341N.A.
17342
17343
17344@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
17345@findex -target-list-parameters
17346
17347@subsubheading Synopsis
17348
17349@smallexample
17350 -target-list-parameters
17351@end smallexample
17352
17353@c ????
17354
17355@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17356
17357No equivalent.
17358
17359@subsubheading Example
17360N.A.
17361
17362
17363@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
17364@findex -target-select
17365
17366@subsubheading Synopsis
17367
17368@smallexample
17369 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
17370@end smallexample
17371
17372Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
17373
17374@table @samp
17375@item @var{type}
17376The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
17377@item @var{parameters}
17378Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
17379Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
17380@end table
17381
17382The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
17383which the target program is, in the following form:
17384
17385@smallexample
17386^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
17387 args=[@var{arg list}]
17388@end smallexample
17389
17390@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17391
17392The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
17393
17394@subsubheading Example
17395
17396@smallexample
17397(@value{GDBP})
17398-target-select async /dev/ttya
17399^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
17400(@value{GDBP})
17401@end smallexample
17402
17403@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17404@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
17405@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
17406
17407
17408@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
17409@findex -thread-info
17410
17411@subsubheading Synopsis
17412
17413@smallexample
17414 -thread-info
17415@end smallexample
17416
17417@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17418
17419No equivalent.
17420
17421@subsubheading Example
17422N.A.
17423
17424
17425@subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
17426@findex -thread-list-all-threads
17427
17428@subsubheading Synopsis
17429
17430@smallexample
17431 -thread-list-all-threads
17432@end smallexample
17433
17434@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17435
17436The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
17437
17438@subsubheading Example
17439N.A.
17440
17441
17442@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
17443@findex -thread-list-ids
17444
17445@subsubheading Synopsis
17446
17447@smallexample
17448 -thread-list-ids
17449@end smallexample
17450
17451Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
17452end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
17453
17454@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17455
17456Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
17457
17458@subsubheading Example
17459
17460No threads present, besides the main process:
17461
17462@smallexample
17463(@value{GDBP})
17464-thread-list-ids
17465^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
17466(@value{GDBP})
17467@end smallexample
17468
17469
17470Several threads:
17471
17472@smallexample
17473(@value{GDBP})
17474-thread-list-ids
17475^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17476number-of-threads="3"
17477(@value{GDBP})
17478@end smallexample
17479
17480
17481@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
17482@findex -thread-select
17483
17484@subsubheading Synopsis
17485
17486@smallexample
17487 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
17488@end smallexample
17489
17490Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
17491current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
17492
17493@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17494
17495The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
17496
17497@subsubheading Example
17498
17499@smallexample
17500(@value{GDBP})
17501-exec-next
17502^running
17503(@value{GDBP})
17504*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
17505file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
17506(@value{GDBP})
17507-thread-list-ids
17508^done,
17509thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17510number-of-threads="3"
17511(@value{GDBP})
17512-thread-select 3
17513^done,new-thread-id="3",
17514frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
17515args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
17516@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
17517(@value{GDBP})
17518@end smallexample
17519
17520@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17521@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
17522@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
17523
17524The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
17525
17526@c @subheading -trace-actions
17527
17528@c @subheading -trace-delete
17529
17530@c @subheading -trace-disable
17531
17532@c @subheading -trace-dump
17533
17534@c @subheading -trace-enable
17535
17536@c @subheading -trace-exists
17537
17538@c @subheading -trace-find
17539
17540@c @subheading -trace-frame-number
17541
17542@c @subheading -trace-info
17543
17544@c @subheading -trace-insert
17545
17546@c @subheading -trace-list
17547
17548@c @subheading -trace-pass-count
17549
17550@c @subheading -trace-save
17551
17552@c @subheading -trace-start
17553
17554@c @subheading -trace-stop
17555
17556
17557@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17558@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
17559@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
17560
17561
17562@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17563
17564For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
17565expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
17566used by @code{Insight}.
17567
17568The two main reasons for that are:
17569
17570@enumerate 1
17571@item
17572It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
17573
17574@item
17575It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
17576now).
17577@end enumerate
17578
17579The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
17580slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
17581describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
17582hints about their use.
17583
17584@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
17585expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
17586least, the following operations:
17587
17588@itemize @bullet
17589@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
17590@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
17591@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
17592@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
17593@end itemize
17594
17595@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17596
17597@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17598The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
17599to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
17600register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
17601examining or changing its properties.
17602
17603Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
17604in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
17605root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
17606is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
17607Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
17608
17609When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
17610for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
17611creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
17612and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
17613chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
17614for pointers, etc.).
17615
17616The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
17617access this functionality:
17618
17619@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
17620@item @strong{Operation}
17621@tab @strong{Description}
17622
17623@item @code{-var-create}
17624@tab create a variable object
17625@item @code{-var-delete}
17626@tab delete the variable object and its children
17627@item @code{-var-set-format}
17628@tab set the display format of this variable
17629@item @code{-var-show-format}
17630@tab show the display format of this variable
17631@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
17632@tab tells how many children this object has
17633@item @code{-var-list-children}
17634@tab return a list of the object's children
17635@item @code{-var-info-type}
17636@tab show the type of this variable object
17637@item @code{-var-info-expression}
17638@tab print what this variable object represents
17639@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
17640@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
17641@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
17642@tab get the value of this variable
17643@item @code{-var-assign}
17644@tab set the value of this variable
17645@item @code{-var-update}
17646@tab update the variable and its children
17647@end multitable
17648
17649In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
17650how it can be used.
17651
17652@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
17653
17654@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
17655@findex -var-create
17656
17657@subsubheading Synopsis
17658
17659@smallexample
17660 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
17661 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
17662@end smallexample
17663
17664This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
17665a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
17666register.
17667
17668The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
17669referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
17670system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
17671unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
17672The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
17673
17674The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
17675specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
17676frame should be used.
17677
17678@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
17679begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
17680
17681@itemize @bullet
17682@item
17683@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
17684
17685@item
17686@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
17687
17688@item
17689@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
17690@end itemize
17691
17692@subsubheading Result
17693
17694This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
17695object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
17696the @value{GDBN} CLI:
17697
17698@smallexample
17699 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
17700@end smallexample
17701
17702
17703@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
17704@findex -var-delete
17705
17706@subsubheading Synopsis
17707
17708@smallexample
17709 -var-delete @var{name}
17710@end smallexample
17711
17712Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
17713
17714Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
17715
17716
17717@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
17718@findex -var-set-format
17719
17720@subsubheading Synopsis
17721
17722@smallexample
17723 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
17724@end smallexample
17725
17726Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
17727@var{format-spec}.
17728
17729The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
17730
17731@smallexample
17732 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
17733 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
17734@end smallexample
17735
17736
17737@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
17738@findex -var-show-format
17739
17740@subsubheading Synopsis
17741
17742@smallexample
17743 -var-show-format @var{name}
17744@end smallexample
17745
17746Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
17747
17748@smallexample
17749 @var{format} @expansion{}
17750 @var{format-spec}
17751@end smallexample
17752
17753
17754@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
17755@findex -var-info-num-children
17756
17757@subsubheading Synopsis
17758
17759@smallexample
17760 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
17761@end smallexample
17762
17763Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
17764
17765@smallexample
17766 numchild=@var{n}
17767@end smallexample
17768
17769
17770@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
17771@findex -var-list-children
17772
17773@subsubheading Synopsis
17774
17775@smallexample
17776 -var-list-children @var{name}
17777@end smallexample
17778
17779Returns a list of the children of the specified variable object:
17780
17781@smallexample
17782 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
17783 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
17784@end smallexample
17785
17786
17787@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
17788@findex -var-info-type
17789
17790@subsubheading Synopsis
17791
17792@smallexample
17793 -var-info-type @var{name}
17794@end smallexample
17795
17796Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
17797returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
17798@value{GDBN} CLI:
17799
17800@smallexample
17801 type=@var{typename}
17802@end smallexample
17803
17804
17805@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
17806@findex -var-info-expression
17807
17808@subsubheading Synopsis
17809
17810@smallexample
17811 -var-info-expression @var{name}
17812@end smallexample
17813
17814Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
17815
17816@smallexample
17817 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
17818@end smallexample
17819
17820@noindent
17821where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
17822
17823@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
17824@findex -var-show-attributes
17825
17826@subsubheading Synopsis
17827
17828@smallexample
17829 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
17830@end smallexample
17831
17832List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
17833
17834@smallexample
17835 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
17836@end smallexample
17837
17838@noindent
17839where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
17840
17841@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
17842@findex -var-evaluate-expression
17843
17844@subsubheading Synopsis
17845
17846@smallexample
17847 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
17848@end smallexample
17849
17850Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
17851object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
17852for the object:
17853
17854@smallexample
17855 value=@var{value}
17856@end smallexample
17857
17858Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
17859before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
17860
17861@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
17862@findex -var-assign
17863
17864@subsubheading Synopsis
17865
17866@smallexample
17867 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
17868@end smallexample
17869
17870Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
17871by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
17872value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
17873subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
17874
17875@subsubheading Example
17876
17877@smallexample
17878(@value{GDBP})
17879-var-assign var1 3
17880^done,value="3"
17881(@value{GDBP})
17882-var-update *
17883^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
17884(@value{GDBP})
17885@end smallexample
17886
17887@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
17888@findex -var-update
17889
17890@subsubheading Synopsis
17891
17892@smallexample
17893 -var-update @{@var{name} | "*"@}
17894@end smallexample
17895
17896Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
17897expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
17898A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated.
17899
17900
17901@node Annotations
17902@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
17903
17904This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations are
17905designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or
17906other similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
17907relatively high level.
17908
17909@ignore
17910This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
17911@end ignore
17912
17913@menu
17914* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
17915* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
17916* Value Annotations:: Values are marked as such.
17917* Frame Annotations:: Stack frames are annotated.
17918* Displays:: @value{GDBN} can be told to display something periodically.
17919* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
17920* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
17921* Breakpoint Info:: Information on breakpoints.
17922* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
17923* Annotations for Running::
17924 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
17925* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
17926* TODO:: Annotations which might be added in the future.
17927@end menu
17928
17929@node Annotations Overview
17930@section What is an Annotation?
17931@cindex annotations
17932
17933To produce annotations, start @value{GDBN} with the @code{--annotate=2} option.
17934
17935Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
17936characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
17937information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
17938is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
17939information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
17940additional information, and a newline. The additional information
17941cannot contain newline characters.
17942
17943Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
17944characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
17945no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
17946@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
17947annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
17948means those three characters as output.
17949
17950A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
17951
17952@smallexample
17953$ gdb --annotate=2
17954GNU GDB 5.0
17955Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
17956GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
17957and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
17958under certain conditions.
17959Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
17960There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
17961for details.
17962This GDB was configured as "sparc-sun-sunos4.1.3"
17963
17964^Z^Zpre-prompt
17965(gdb)
17966^Z^Zprompt
17967quit
17968
17969^Z^Zpost-prompt
17970$
17971@end smallexample
17972
17973Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
17974@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
17975denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
17976output from @value{GDBN}.
17977
17978@node Server Prefix
17979@section The Server Prefix
17980@cindex server prefix for annotations
17981
17982To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
17983the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
17984means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
17985affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
17986pressed on a line by itself.
17987
17988The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
17989history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
17990use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
17991
17992@node Value Annotations
17993@section Values
17994
17995@cindex annotations for values
17996When a value is printed in various contexts, @value{GDBN} uses
17997annotations to delimit the value from the surrounding text.
17998
17999@findex value-history-begin
18000@findex value-history-value
18001@findex value-history-end
18002If a value is printed using @code{print} and added to the value history,
18003the annotation looks like
18004
18005@smallexample
18006^Z^Zvalue-history-begin @var{history-number} @var{value-flags}
18007@var{history-string}
18008^Z^Zvalue-history-value
18009@var{the-value}
18010^Z^Zvalue-history-end
18011@end smallexample
18012
18013@noindent
18014where @var{history-number} is the number it is getting in the value
18015history, @var{history-string} is a string, such as @samp{$5 = }, which
18016introduces the value to the user, @var{the-value} is the output
18017corresponding to the value itself, and @var{value-flags} is @samp{*} for
18018a value which can be dereferenced and @samp{-} for a value which cannot.
18019
18020@findex value-begin
18021@findex value-end
18022If the value is not added to the value history (it is an invalid float
18023or it is printed with the @code{output} command), the annotation is similar:
18024
18025@smallexample
18026^Z^Zvalue-begin @var{value-flags}
18027@var{the-value}
18028^Z^Zvalue-end
18029@end smallexample
18030
18031@findex arg-begin
18032@findex arg-name-end
18033@findex arg-value
18034@findex arg-end
18035When @value{GDBN} prints an argument to a function (for example, in the output
18036from the @code{backtrace} command), it annotates it as follows:
18037
18038@smallexample
18039^Z^Zarg-begin
18040@var{argument-name}
18041^Z^Zarg-name-end
18042@var{separator-string}
18043^Z^Zarg-value @var{value-flags}
18044@var{the-value}
18045^Z^Zarg-end
18046@end smallexample
18047
18048@noindent
18049where @var{argument-name} is the name of the argument,
18050@var{separator-string} is text which separates the name from the value
18051for the user's benefit (such as @samp{=}), and @var{value-flags} and
18052@var{the-value} have the same meanings as in a
18053@code{value-history-begin} annotation.
18054
18055@findex field-begin
18056@findex field-name-end
18057@findex field-value
18058@findex field-end
18059When printing a structure, @value{GDBN} annotates it as follows:
18060
18061@smallexample
18062^Z^Zfield-begin @var{value-flags}
18063@var{field-name}
18064^Z^Zfield-name-end
18065@var{separator-string}
18066^Z^Zfield-value
18067@var{the-value}
18068^Z^Zfield-end
18069@end smallexample
18070
18071@noindent
18072where @var{field-name} is the name of the field, @var{separator-string}
18073is text which separates the name from the value for the user's benefit
18074(such as @samp{=}), and @var{value-flags} and @var{the-value} have the
18075same meanings as in a @code{value-history-begin} annotation.
18076
18077When printing an array, @value{GDBN} annotates it as follows:
18078
18079@smallexample
18080^Z^Zarray-section-begin @var{array-index} @var{value-flags}
18081@end smallexample
18082
18083@noindent
18084where @var{array-index} is the index of the first element being
18085annotated and @var{value-flags} has the same meaning as in a
18086@code{value-history-begin} annotation. This is followed by any number
18087of elements, where is element can be either a single element:
18088
18089@findex elt
18090@smallexample
18091@samp{,} @var{whitespace} ; @r{omitted for the first element}
18092@var{the-value}
18093^Z^Zelt
18094@end smallexample
18095
18096or a repeated element
18097
18098@findex elt-rep
18099@findex elt-rep-end
18100@smallexample
18101@samp{,} @var{whitespace} ; @r{omitted for the first element}
18102@var{the-value}
18103^Z^Zelt-rep @var{number-of-repetitions}
18104@var{repetition-string}
18105^Z^Zelt-rep-end
18106@end smallexample
18107
18108In both cases, @var{the-value} is the output for the value of the
18109element and @var{whitespace} can contain spaces, tabs, and newlines. In
18110the repeated case, @var{number-of-repetitions} is the number of
18111consecutive array elements which contain that value, and
18112@var{repetition-string} is a string which is designed to convey to the
18113user that repetition is being depicted.
18114
18115@findex array-section-end
18116Once all the array elements have been output, the array annotation is
18117ended with
18118
18119@smallexample
18120^Z^Zarray-section-end
18121@end smallexample
18122
18123@node Frame Annotations
18124@section Frames
18125
18126@cindex annotations for frames
18127Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a frame, it annotates it. For example, this applies
18128to frames printed when @value{GDBN} stops, output from commands such as
18129@code{backtrace} or @code{up}, etc.
18130
18131@findex frame-begin
18132The frame annotation begins with
18133
18134@smallexample
18135^Z^Zframe-begin @var{level} @var{address}
18136@var{level-string}
18137@end smallexample
18138
18139@noindent
18140where @var{level} is the number of the frame (0 is the innermost frame,
18141and other frames have positive numbers), @var{address} is the address of
18142the code executing in that frame, and @var{level-string} is a string
18143designed to convey the level to the user. @var{address} is in the form
18144@samp{0x} followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this
18145does not depend on the language). The frame ends with
18146
18147@findex frame-end
18148@smallexample
18149^Z^Zframe-end
18150@end smallexample
18151
18152Between these annotations is the main body of the frame, which can
18153consist of
18154
18155@itemize @bullet
18156@item
18157@findex function-call
18158@smallexample
18159^Z^Zfunction-call
18160@var{function-call-string}
18161@end smallexample
18162
18163where @var{function-call-string} is text designed to convey to the user
18164that this frame is associated with a function call made by @value{GDBN} to a
18165function in the program being debugged.
18166
18167@item
18168@findex signal-handler-caller
18169@smallexample
18170^Z^Zsignal-handler-caller
18171@var{signal-handler-caller-string}
18172@end smallexample
18173
18174where @var{signal-handler-caller-string} is text designed to convey to
18175the user that this frame is associated with whatever mechanism is used
18176by this operating system to call a signal handler (it is the frame which
18177calls the signal handler, not the frame for the signal handler itself).
18178
18179@item
18180A normal frame.
18181
18182@findex frame-address
18183@findex frame-address-end
18184This can optionally (depending on whether this is thought of as
18185interesting information for the user to see) begin with
18186
18187@smallexample
18188^Z^Zframe-address
18189@var{address}
18190^Z^Zframe-address-end
18191@var{separator-string}
18192@end smallexample
18193
18194where @var{address} is the address executing in the frame (the same
18195address as in the @code{frame-begin} annotation, but printed in a form
18196which is intended for user consumption---in particular, the syntax varies
18197depending on the language), and @var{separator-string} is a string
18198intended to separate this address from what follows for the user's
18199benefit.
18200
18201@findex frame-function-name
18202@findex frame-args
18203Then comes
18204
18205@smallexample
18206^Z^Zframe-function-name
18207@var{function-name}
18208^Z^Zframe-args
18209@var{arguments}
18210@end smallexample
18211
18212where @var{function-name} is the name of the function executing in the
18213frame, or @samp{??} if not known, and @var{arguments} are the arguments
18214to the frame, with parentheses around them (each argument is annotated
18215individually as well, @pxref{Value Annotations}).
18216
18217@findex frame-source-begin
18218@findex frame-source-file
18219@findex frame-source-file-end
18220@findex frame-source-line
18221@findex frame-source-end
18222If source information is available, a reference to it is then printed:
18223
18224@smallexample
18225^Z^Zframe-source-begin
18226@var{source-intro-string}
18227^Z^Zframe-source-file
18228@var{filename}
18229^Z^Zframe-source-file-end
18230:
18231^Z^Zframe-source-line
18232@var{line-number}
18233^Z^Zframe-source-end
18234@end smallexample
18235
18236where @var{source-intro-string} separates for the user's benefit the
18237reference from the text which precedes it, @var{filename} is the name of
18238the source file, and @var{line-number} is the line number within that
18239file (the first line is line 1).
18240
18241@findex frame-where
18242If @value{GDBN} prints some information about where the frame is from (which
18243library, which load segment, etc.; currently only done on the RS/6000),
18244it is annotated with
18245
18246@smallexample
18247^Z^Zframe-where
18248@var{information}
18249@end smallexample
18250
18251Then, if source is to actually be displayed for this frame (for example,
18252this is not true for output from the @code{backtrace} command), then a
18253@code{source} annotation (@pxref{Source Annotations}) is displayed. Unlike
18254most annotations, this is output instead of the normal text which would be
18255output, not in addition.
18256@end itemize
18257
18258@node Displays
18259@section Displays
18260
18261@findex display-begin
18262@findex display-number-end
18263@findex display-format
18264@findex display-expression
18265@findex display-expression-end
18266@findex display-value
18267@findex display-end
18268@cindex annotations for display
18269When @value{GDBN} is told to display something using the @code{display} command,
18270the results of the display are annotated:
18271
18272@smallexample
18273^Z^Zdisplay-begin
18274@var{number}
18275^Z^Zdisplay-number-end
18276@var{number-separator}
18277^Z^Zdisplay-format
18278@var{format}
18279^Z^Zdisplay-expression
18280@var{expression}
18281^Z^Zdisplay-expression-end
18282@var{expression-separator}
18283^Z^Zdisplay-value
18284@var{value}
18285^Z^Zdisplay-end
18286@end smallexample
18287
18288@noindent
18289where @var{number} is the number of the display, @var{number-separator}
18290is intended to separate the number from what follows for the user,
18291@var{format} includes information such as the size, format, or other
18292information about how the value is being displayed, @var{expression} is
18293the expression being displayed, @var{expression-separator} is intended
18294to separate the expression from the text that follows for the user,
18295and @var{value} is the actual value being displayed.
18296
18297@node Prompting
18298@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
18299
18300@cindex annotations for prompts
18301When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
18302to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
18303over, etc.
18304
18305Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
18306input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
18307denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
18308annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
18309annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
18310associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
18311features the following annotations:
18312
18313@smallexample
18314^Z^Zpre-prompt
18315^Z^Zprompt
18316^Z^Zpost-prompt
18317@end smallexample
18318
18319The input types are
18320
18321@table @code
18322@findex pre-prompt
18323@findex prompt
18324@findex post-prompt
18325@item prompt
18326When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
18327
18328@findex pre-commands
18329@findex commands
18330@findex post-commands
18331@item commands
18332When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
18333command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
18334
18335@findex pre-overload-choice
18336@findex overload-choice
18337@findex post-overload-choice
18338@item overload-choice
18339When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
18340
18341@findex pre-query
18342@findex query
18343@findex post-query
18344@item query
18345When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
18346
18347@findex pre-prompt-for-continue
18348@findex prompt-for-continue
18349@findex post-prompt-for-continue
18350@item prompt-for-continue
18351When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
18352expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
18353prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
18354presence of annotations.
18355@end table
18356
18357@node Errors
18358@section Errors
18359@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
18360
18361@findex quit
18362@smallexample
18363^Z^Zquit
18364@end smallexample
18365
18366This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
18367
18368@findex error
18369@smallexample
18370^Z^Zerror
18371@end smallexample
18372
18373This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
18374
18375Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
18376in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
18377@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
18378cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
18379cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
18380does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
18381to the top level.
18382
18383@findex error-begin
18384A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
18385
18386@smallexample
18387^Z^Zerror-begin
18388@end smallexample
18389
18390Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
18391message.
18392
18393Warning messages are not yet annotated.
18394@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
18395@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
18396
18397@node Breakpoint Info
18398@section Information on Breakpoints
18399
18400@cindex annotations for breakpoints
18401The output from the @code{info breakpoints} command is annotated as follows:
18402
18403@findex breakpoints-headers
18404@findex breakpoints-table
18405@smallexample
18406^Z^Zbreakpoints-headers
18407@var{header-entry}
18408^Z^Zbreakpoints-table
18409@end smallexample
18410
18411@noindent
18412where @var{header-entry} has the same syntax as an entry (see below) but
18413instead of containing data, it contains strings which are intended to
18414convey the meaning of each field to the user. This is followed by any
18415number of entries. If a field does not apply for this entry, it is
18416omitted. Fields may contain trailing whitespace. Each entry consists
18417of:
18418
18419@findex record
18420@findex field
18421@smallexample
18422^Z^Zrecord
18423^Z^Zfield 0
18424@var{number}
18425^Z^Zfield 1
18426@var{type}
18427^Z^Zfield 2
18428@var{disposition}
18429^Z^Zfield 3
18430@var{enable}
18431^Z^Zfield 4
18432@var{address}
18433^Z^Zfield 5
18434@var{what}
18435^Z^Zfield 6
18436@var{frame}
18437^Z^Zfield 7
18438@var{condition}
18439^Z^Zfield 8
18440@var{ignore-count}
18441^Z^Zfield 9
18442@var{commands}
18443@end smallexample
18444
18445Note that @var{address} is intended for user consumption---the syntax
18446varies depending on the language.
18447
18448The output ends with
18449
18450@findex breakpoints-table-end
18451@smallexample
18452^Z^Zbreakpoints-table-end
18453@end smallexample
18454
18455@node Invalidation
18456@section Invalidation Notices
18457
18458@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
18459The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
18460changed.
18461
18462@table @code
18463@findex frames-invalid
18464@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
18465
18466The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
18467have changed.
18468
18469@findex breakpoints-invalid
18470@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
18471
18472The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
18473deleted a breakpoint.
18474@end table
18475
18476@node Annotations for Running
18477@section Running the Program
18478@cindex annotations for running programs
18479
18480@findex starting
18481@findex stopping
18482When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
18483@code{step} or @code{continue},
18484
18485@smallexample
18486^Z^Zstarting
18487@end smallexample
18488
18489is output. When the program stops,
18490
18491@smallexample
18492^Z^Zstopped
18493@end smallexample
18494
18495is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
18496annotations describe how the program stopped.
18497
18498@table @code
18499@findex exited
18500@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
18501The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
18502successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
18503
18504@findex signalled
18505@findex signal-name
18506@findex signal-name-end
18507@findex signal-string
18508@findex signal-string-end
18509@item ^Z^Zsignalled
18510The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
18511annotation continues:
18512
18513@smallexample
18514@var{intro-text}
18515^Z^Zsignal-name
18516@var{name}
18517^Z^Zsignal-name-end
18518@var{middle-text}
18519^Z^Zsignal-string
18520@var{string}
18521^Z^Zsignal-string-end
18522@var{end-text}
18523@end smallexample
18524
18525@noindent
18526where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
18527@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
18528as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
18529@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
18530user's benefit and have no particular format.
18531
18532@findex signal
18533@item ^Z^Zsignal
18534The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
18535just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
18536terminated with it.
18537
18538@findex breakpoint
18539@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
18540The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
18541
18542@findex watchpoint
18543@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
18544The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
18545@end table
18546
18547@node Source Annotations
18548@section Displaying Source
18549@cindex annotations for source display
18550
18551@findex source
18552The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
18553
18554@smallexample
18555^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
18556@end smallexample
18557
18558where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
18559file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
18560first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
18561within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
18562debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
18563@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
18564line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
18565@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
18566source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
18567followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
18568depend on the language).
18569
18570@node TODO
18571@section Annotations We Might Want in the Future
18572
18573@format
18574 - target-invalid
18575 the target might have changed (registers, heap contents, or
18576 execution status). For performance, we might eventually want
18577 to hit `registers-invalid' and `all-registers-invalid' with
18578 greater precision
18579
18580 - systematic annotation for set/show parameters (including
18581 invalidation notices).
18582
18583 - similarly, `info' returns a list of candidates for invalidation
18584 notices.
18585@end format
c906108c 18586
8e04817f
AC
18587@node GDB Bugs
18588@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
18589@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
18590@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 18591
8e04817f 18592Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 18593
8e04817f
AC
18594Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
18595may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
18596the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
18597reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 18598
8e04817f
AC
18599In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
18600information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
18601
18602@menu
8e04817f
AC
18603* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
18604* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
18605@end menu
18606
8e04817f
AC
18607@node Bug Criteria
18608@section Have you found a bug?
18609@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 18610
8e04817f 18611If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
18612
18613@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
18614@cindex fatal signal
18615@cindex debugger crash
18616@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 18617@item
8e04817f
AC
18618If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
18619@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
18620
18621@cindex error on valid input
18622@item
18623If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
18624bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
18625somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 18626
8e04817f 18627@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 18628@item
8e04817f
AC
18629If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
18630that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
18631``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
18632for traditional practice''.
18633
18634@item
18635If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
18636for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
18637@end itemize
18638
8e04817f
AC
18639@node Bug Reporting
18640@section How to report bugs
18641@cindex bug reports
18642@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
18643
18644A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
18645If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
18646contact that organization first.
18647
18648You can find contact information for many support companies and
18649individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
18650distribution.
18651@c should add a web page ref...
18652
129188f6
AC
18653In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
18654@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
18655@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
18656page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
18657be used.
8e04817f
AC
18658
18659@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
18660@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
18661not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
18662@samp{bug-gdb}.
18663
18664The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
18665serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
18666the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
18667newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
18668problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
18669path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
18670we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
18671bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 18672
8e04817f
AC
18673The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
18674@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
18675fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 18676
8e04817f
AC
18677Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
18678problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
18679assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
18680Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
18681stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
18682name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
18683of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
18684the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
18685easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 18686
8e04817f
AC
18687Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
18688bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
18689you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
18690self-contained.
c4555f82 18691
8e04817f
AC
18692Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
18693bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
18694@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
18695bugs properly.
18696
18697To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
18698
18699@itemize @bullet
18700@item
8e04817f
AC
18701The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
18702with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
18703version}.
c4555f82 18704
8e04817f
AC
18705Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
18706the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
18707
18708@item
8e04817f
AC
18709The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
18710version number.
c4555f82
SC
18711
18712@item
8e04817f
AC
18713What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
18714``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
18715
18716@item
8e04817f
AC
18717What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
18718debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
18719C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
18720information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
18721compilers.
c4555f82 18722
8e04817f
AC
18723@item
18724The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
18725observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
18726you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
18727Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 18728
8e04817f
AC
18729If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
18730and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 18731
8e04817f
AC
18732@item
18733A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
18734reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 18735
8e04817f
AC
18736@item
18737A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
18738incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 18739
8e04817f
AC
18740Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
18741will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
18742not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
18743a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 18744
8e04817f
AC
18745Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
18746say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
18747copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
18748the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
18749crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
18750ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
18751us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
18752to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 18753
8e04817f
AC
18754@item
18755If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
18756diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
18757it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 18758
8e04817f
AC
18759The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
18760sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 18761
8e04817f 18762@end itemize
c4555f82 18763
8e04817f 18764Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 18765
8e04817f
AC
18766@itemize @bullet
18767@item
18768A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 18769
8e04817f
AC
18770Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
18771which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
18772changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 18773
8e04817f
AC
18774This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
18775will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
18776with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
18777We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 18778
8e04817f
AC
18779Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
18780of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
18781output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
18782less time, and so on.
c4555f82 18783
8e04817f
AC
18784However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
18785report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 18786
8e04817f
AC
18787@item
18788A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 18789
8e04817f
AC
18790A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
18791the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
18792a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
18793to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 18794
8e04817f
AC
18795Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
18796construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
18797through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
18798to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 18799
8e04817f
AC
18800And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
18801patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
18802help us to understand.
c4555f82 18803
8e04817f
AC
18804@item
18805A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 18806
8e04817f
AC
18807Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
18808things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
18809@end itemize
c4555f82 18810
8e04817f
AC
18811@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
18812@c and consists of the two following files:
18813@c rluser.texinfo
18814@c inc-hist.texinfo
18815@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
18816@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
18817@include rluser.texinfo
18818@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 18819
c4555f82 18820
8e04817f
AC
18821@node Formatting Documentation
18822@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 18823
8e04817f
AC
18824@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
18825@cindex reference card
18826The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
18827for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
18828subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
18829@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
18830release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
18831you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 18832
8e04817f
AC
18833The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
18834can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 18835
474c8240 18836@smallexample
8e04817f 18837make refcard.dvi
474c8240 18838@end smallexample
c4555f82 18839
8e04817f
AC
18840The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
18841mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
18842that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
18843high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
18844your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 18845
8e04817f 18846@cindex documentation
c4555f82 18847
8e04817f
AC
18848All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
18849distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
18850a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
18851on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
18852formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
18853and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 18854
8e04817f
AC
18855@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
18856version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
18857file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
18858subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
18859necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
18860but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
18861Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
18862@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 18863
8e04817f
AC
18864If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
18865Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
18866@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 18867
8e04817f
AC
18868If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
18869@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
18870version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 18871
474c8240 18872@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
18873cd gdb
18874make gdb.info
474c8240 18875@end smallexample
c4555f82 18876
8e04817f
AC
18877If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
18878a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
18879Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 18880
8e04817f
AC
18881@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
18882produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
18883document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
18884has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
18885command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
18886(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
18887require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 18888
8e04817f
AC
18889@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
18890@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
18891written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
18892typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
18893and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
18894directory.
c4555f82 18895
8e04817f
AC
18896If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
18897typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
18898subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
18899@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 18900
474c8240 18901@smallexample
8e04817f 18902make gdb.dvi
474c8240 18903@end smallexample
c4555f82 18904
8e04817f 18905Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 18906
8e04817f
AC
18907@node Installing GDB
18908@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
18909@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
18910@cindex installation
94e91d6d 18911@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
c4555f82 18912
8e04817f
AC
18913@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
18914of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
18915build the @code{gdb} program.
18916@iftex
18917@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
18918@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
18919look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
18920installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
18921@end iftex
c4555f82 18922
8e04817f
AC
18923The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
18924@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
18925appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 18926
8e04817f
AC
18927For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
18928@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 18929
8e04817f
AC
18930@table @code
18931@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
18932script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 18933
8e04817f
AC
18934@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
18935the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 18936
8e04817f
AC
18937@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
18938source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 18939
8e04817f
AC
18940@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
18941@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 18942
8e04817f
AC
18943@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
18944source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 18945
8e04817f
AC
18946@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
18947source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 18948
8e04817f
AC
18949@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
18950source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 18951
8e04817f
AC
18952@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
18953source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 18954
8e04817f
AC
18955@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
18956source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
18957@end table
c906108c 18958
8e04817f
AC
18959The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
18960from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
18961this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 18962
8e04817f
AC
18963First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
18964if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
18965identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
18966argument.
c906108c 18967
8e04817f 18968For example:
c906108c 18969
474c8240 18970@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
18971cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
18972./configure @var{host}
18973make
474c8240 18974@end smallexample
c906108c 18975
8e04817f
AC
18976@noindent
18977where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
18978@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
18979(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
18980correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 18981
8e04817f
AC
18982Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
18983@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
18984libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
18985binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 18986
8e04817f
AC
18987@need 750
18988@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
18989system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
18990shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 18991
474c8240 18992@smallexample
8e04817f 18993sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 18994@end smallexample
c906108c 18995
8e04817f
AC
18996If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
18997directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
18998@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
18999creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
19000you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
19001
94e91d6d
MC
19002You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
19003source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
19004@code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
19005that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
19006if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
19007of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
19008configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
19009directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
19010about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
c906108c 19011
8e04817f
AC
19012You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
19013However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
19014the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
19015that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
19016let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 19017
8e04817f
AC
19018@menu
19019* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
19020* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
19021* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
19022@end menu
c906108c 19023
8e04817f
AC
19024@node Separate Objdir
19025@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 19026
8e04817f
AC
19027If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
19028you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
19029host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
19030allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
19031rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
19032handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
19033@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
19034program specified there.
c906108c 19035
8e04817f
AC
19036To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
19037with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
19038(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
19039itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
19040would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
19041the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 19042
8e04817f
AC
19043For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
19044separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 19045
474c8240 19046@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19047@group
19048cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19049mkdir ../gdb-sun4
19050cd ../gdb-sun4
19051../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
19052make
19053@end group
474c8240 19054@end smallexample
c906108c 19055
8e04817f
AC
19056When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
19057directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
19058(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
19059the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
19060directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
19061@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 19062
94e91d6d
MC
19063Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
19064instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
19065like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
19066one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
19067build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19068
8e04817f
AC
19069One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
19070directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
19071@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
19072programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
19073You specify a cross-debugging target by
19074giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 19075
8e04817f
AC
19076When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
19077it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
19078called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 19079
8e04817f
AC
19080The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
19081directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
19082directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
19083directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
19084will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 19085
8e04817f
AC
19086When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
19087directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
19088if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
19089with each other.
c906108c 19090
8e04817f
AC
19091@node Config Names
19092@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 19093
8e04817f
AC
19094The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
19095script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
19096aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
19097of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 19098
474c8240 19099@smallexample
8e04817f 19100@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 19101@end smallexample
c906108c 19102
8e04817f
AC
19103For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
19104or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
19105option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 19106
8e04817f
AC
19107The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
19108any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
19109aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
19110@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
19111script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
19112abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 19113
8e04817f
AC
19114@smallexample
19115% sh config.sub i386-linux
19116i386-pc-linux-gnu
19117% sh config.sub alpha-linux
19118alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
19119% sh config.sub hp9k700
19120hppa1.1-hp-hpux
19121% sh config.sub sun4
19122sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
19123% sh config.sub sun3
19124m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
19125% sh config.sub i986v
19126Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
19127@end smallexample
c906108c 19128
8e04817f
AC
19129@noindent
19130@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
19131directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 19132
8e04817f
AC
19133@node Configure Options
19134@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 19135
8e04817f
AC
19136Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
19137are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
19138several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
19139Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 19140
474c8240 19141@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19142configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
19143 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19144 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19145 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
19146 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
19147 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
19148 @var{host}
474c8240 19149@end smallexample
c906108c 19150
8e04817f
AC
19151@noindent
19152You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
19153@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
19154@samp{--}.
c906108c 19155
8e04817f
AC
19156@table @code
19157@item --help
19158Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 19159
8e04817f
AC
19160@item --prefix=@var{dir}
19161Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
19162@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 19163
8e04817f
AC
19164@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
19165Configure the source to install programs under directory
19166@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 19167
8e04817f
AC
19168@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
19169@need 2000
19170@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
19171@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
19172@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
19173Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
19174@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
19175build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
19176directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
19177the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
19178directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
19179the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
19180@var{dirname}.
c906108c 19181
8e04817f
AC
19182@item --norecursion
19183Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
19184propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 19185
8e04817f
AC
19186@item --target=@var{target}
19187Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
19188@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
19189programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 19190
8e04817f 19191There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 19192
8e04817f
AC
19193@item @var{host} @dots{}
19194Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 19195
8e04817f
AC
19196There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
19197@end table
c906108c 19198
8e04817f
AC
19199There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
19200needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 19201
8e04817f
AC
19202@node Maintenance Commands
19203@appendix Maintenance Commands
19204@cindex maintenance commands
19205@cindex internal commands
c906108c 19206
8e04817f
AC
19207In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
19208includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
19209These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 19210
8e04817f
AC
19211@table @code
19212@kindex maint info breakpoints
19213@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
19214Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
19215breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
19216internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
19217breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
19218is shown:
c906108c 19219
8e04817f
AC
19220@table @code
19221@item breakpoint
19222Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 19223
8e04817f
AC
19224@item watchpoint
19225Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 19226
8e04817f
AC
19227@item longjmp
19228Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
19229@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 19230
8e04817f
AC
19231@item longjmp resume
19232Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 19233
8e04817f
AC
19234@item until
19235Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 19236
8e04817f
AC
19237@item finish
19238Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 19239
8e04817f
AC
19240@item shlib events
19241Shared library events.
c906108c 19242
8e04817f 19243@end table
c906108c 19244
8d30a00d
AC
19245@kindex maint internal-error
19246@kindex maint internal-warning
19247@item maint internal-error
19248@itemx maint internal-warning
19249Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
19250or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
19251or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
19252internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
19253either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
19254@value{GDBN} session.
19255
19256@smallexample
19257(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
19258@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
19259A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
19260debugging may prove unreliable.
19261Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19262Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19263(gdb)
19264@end smallexample
19265
19266Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
19267warning message.
19268
0680b120
AC
19269@kindex maint print registers
19270@kindex maint print raw-registers
19271@kindex maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 19272@kindex maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
19273@item maint print registers
19274@itemx maint print raw-registers
19275@itemx maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 19276@itemx maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
19277Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
19278
617073a9
AC
19279The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
19280the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
19281includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
19282@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
19283register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
19284@value{GDBN} Internals}.
0680b120
AC
19285
19286Takes an optional file parameter.
19287
617073a9
AC
19288@kindex maint print reggroups
19289@item maint print reggroups
19290Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
19291
19292Takes an optional file parameter.
19293
19294@smallexample
19295(gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
19296 Group Type
19297 general user
19298 float user
19299 all user
19300 vector user
19301 system user
19302 save internal
19303 restore internal
19304@end smallexample
19305
e7ba9c65
DJ
19306@kindex maint set profile
19307@kindex maint show profile
19308@cindex profiling GDB
19309@item maint set profile
19310@itemx maint show profile
19311Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
19312
19313Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
19314command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
19315collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
19316exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
19317if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
19318(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
19319data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
19320
19321Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
19322compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
19323
8e04817f 19324@end table
c906108c 19325
c906108c 19326
e0ce93ac 19327@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 19328@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 19329
ee2d5c50
AC
19330@menu
19331* Overview::
19332* Packets::
19333* Stop Reply Packets::
19334* General Query Packets::
19335* Register Packet Format::
19336* Examples::
0ce1b118 19337* File-I/O remote protocol extension::
ee2d5c50
AC
19338@end menu
19339
19340@node Overview
19341@section Overview
19342
8e04817f
AC
19343There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
19344protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
19345machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
19346recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 19347
d2c6833e 19348In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 19349transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 19350
8e04817f
AC
19351@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
19352@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
19353@cindex remote serial protocol
19354All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
19355sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
19356@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
19357@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 19358
474c8240 19359@smallexample
8e04817f 19360@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 19361@end smallexample
8e04817f 19362@noindent
c906108c 19363
8e04817f
AC
19364@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
19365@noindent
19366The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
19367characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
19368eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 19369
8e04817f
AC
19370Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
19371specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 19372
474c8240 19373@smallexample
8e04817f 19374@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 19375@end smallexample
c906108c 19376
8e04817f
AC
19377@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
19378@noindent
19379That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
19380has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
19381since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 19382
8e04817f
AC
19383@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
19384When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
19385response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
19386the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
19387retransmission):
c906108c 19388
474c8240 19389@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
19390-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19391<- @code{+}
474c8240 19392@end smallexample
8e04817f 19393@noindent
53a5351d 19394
8e04817f
AC
19395The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
19396debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
19397the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
19398when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 19399
8e04817f
AC
19400@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
19401exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
19402exceptions).
c906108c 19403
8e04817f 19404Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 19405@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 19406@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 19407@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 19408
8e04817f
AC
19409Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
19410@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
19411would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 19412
8e04817f
AC
19413Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
19414means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
19415which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
19416@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
19417where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
19418characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
19419value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 19420
8e04817f
AC
19421Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
19422loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
19423character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 19424
8e04817f 19425So:
474c8240 19426@smallexample
8e04817f 19427"@code{0* }"
474c8240 19428@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19429@noindent
19430means the same as "0000".
c906108c 19431
8e04817f
AC
19432The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
19433error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 19434
8e04817f
AC
19435For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
19436(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
19437protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
19438on that response.
c906108c 19439
8e04817f
AC
19440A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
19441@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
19442optional.
c906108c 19443
ee2d5c50
AC
19444@node Packets
19445@section Packets
19446
19447The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
19448@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
19449
19450@table @r
19451
19452@item @code{!} --- extended mode
19453@cindex @code{!} packet
19454
8e04817f
AC
19455Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
19456persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
19457debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
19458
19459Reply:
19460@table @samp
19461@item OK
8e04817f 19462The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 19463@end table
c906108c 19464
ee2d5c50
AC
19465@item @code{?} --- last signal
19466@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 19467
ee2d5c50
AC
19468Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
19469step and continue.
c906108c 19470
ee2d5c50
AC
19471Reply:
19472@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19473
19474@item @code{a} --- reserved
19475
19476Reserved for future use.
19477
19478@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
19479@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 19480
8e04817f
AC
19481Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
19482specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
19483See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
19484
19485Reply:
19486@table @samp
19487@item OK
19488@item E@var{NN}
19489@end table
19490
19491@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
19492@cindex @code{b} packet
19493
19494Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
19495
19496JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
19497received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
19498problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
19499
19500Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
19501it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
19502some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
19503switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
19504of view, nothing actually happened.}
19505
19506@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
19507@cindex @code{B} packet
19508
8e04817f 19509Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
19510breakpoint at @var{addr}.
19511
19512This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
19513(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 19514
ee2d5c50
AC
19515@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
19516@cindex @code{c} packet
19517
19518@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 19519current address.
c906108c 19520
ee2d5c50
AC
19521Reply:
19522@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19523
19524@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
19525@cindex @code{C} packet
19526
8e04817f
AC
19527Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
19528@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 19529
ee2d5c50
AC
19530Reply:
19531@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 19532
ee2d5c50
AC
19533@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
19534@cindex @code{d} packet
19535
19536Toggle debug flag.
19537
19538@item @code{D} --- detach
19539@cindex @code{D} packet
19540
19541Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
19542before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
19543
19544Reply:
19545@table @samp
19546@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 19547@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 19548@end table
c906108c 19549
ee2d5c50 19550@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 19551
ee2d5c50 19552Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19553
ee2d5c50 19554@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 19555
ee2d5c50 19556Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19557
ee2d5c50
AC
19558@item @code{f} --- reserved
19559
19560Reserved for future use.
19561
0ce1b118
CV
19562@item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
19563@cindex @code{F} packet
ee2d5c50 19564
0ce1b118
CV
19565This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
19566sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
19567@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
ee2d5c50
AC
19568
19569@item @code{g} --- read registers
19570@anchor{read registers packet}
19571@cindex @code{g} packet
19572
19573Read general registers.
19574
19575Reply:
19576@table @samp
19577@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
19578Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
19579with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
19580each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
19581determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
19582and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 19583@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
19584@item E@var{NN}
19585for an error.
19586@end table
c906108c 19587
ee2d5c50
AC
19588@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
19589@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 19590
ee2d5c50
AC
19591@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
19592data.
19593
19594Reply:
19595@table @samp
19596@item OK
19597for success
19598@item E@var{NN}
19599for an error
19600@end table
19601
19602@item @code{h} --- reserved
19603
19604Reserved for future use.
19605
19606@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
19607@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 19608
8e04817f 19609Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
19610@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
19611should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
19612operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
19613the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
19614
19615Reply:
19616@table @samp
19617@item OK
19618for success
19619@item E@var{NN}
19620for an error
19621@end table
c906108c 19622
8e04817f
AC
19623@c FIXME: JTC:
19624@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
19625@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
19626@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
19627@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
19628@c described. For example:
19629@c
19630@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19631@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
19632@c otherwise returns current registers.
19633@c
19634@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19635@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
19636@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 19637
ee2d5c50
AC
19638@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
19639@anchor{cycle step packet}
19640@cindex @code{i} packet
19641
8e04817f
AC
19642Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
19643present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
19644step starting at that address.
c906108c 19645
ee2d5c50
AC
19646@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
19647@cindex @code{I} packet
19648
19649@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
19650
19651@item @code{j} --- reserved
19652
19653Reserved for future use.
19654
19655@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 19656
ee2d5c50 19657Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19658
ee2d5c50
AC
19659@item @code{k} --- kill request
19660@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 19661
ac282366 19662FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
19663thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
19664thread?)}.
c906108c 19665
ee2d5c50 19666@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 19667
ee2d5c50
AC
19668Reserved for future use.
19669
19670@item @code{l} --- reserved
19671
19672Reserved for future use.
19673
19674@item @code{L} --- reserved
19675
19676Reserved for future use.
19677
19678@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
19679@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 19680
8e04817f 19681Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 19682Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 19683assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 19684transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 19685
ee2d5c50
AC
19686Reply:
19687@table @samp
19688@item @var{XX@dots{}}
19689@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
19690to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 19691that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
19692accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
19693needed.}
19694@item E@var{NN}
19695@var{NN} is errno
19696@end table
19697
19698@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
19699@cindex @code{M} packet
19700
8e04817f 19701Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
19702@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
19703
19704Reply:
19705@table @samp
19706@item OK
19707for success
19708@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
19709for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
19710written).
ee2d5c50 19711@end table
c906108c 19712
ee2d5c50 19713@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 19714
ee2d5c50 19715Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19716
ee2d5c50 19717@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 19718
ee2d5c50 19719Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19720
ee2d5c50
AC
19721@item @code{o} --- reserved
19722
19723Reserved for future use.
19724
19725@item @code{O} --- reserved
19726
19727Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19728
ee2d5c50
AC
19729@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
19730@cindex @code{p} packet
19731
19732@xref{write register packet}.
19733
19734Reply:
19735@table @samp
19736@item @var{r@dots{}.}
19737The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
19738@end table
19739
19740@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
19741@anchor{write register packet}
19742@cindex @code{P} packet
19743
19744Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 19745digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 19746
ee2d5c50
AC
19747Reply:
19748@table @samp
19749@item OK
19750for success
19751@item E@var{NN}
19752for an error
19753@end table
19754
19755@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
19756@anchor{general query packet}
19757@cindex @code{q} packet
19758
19759Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
19760leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
19761prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
19762be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
19763that they match the full @var{query} name.
19764
19765Reply:
19766@table @samp
19767@item @var{XX@dots{}}
19768Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
19769@item E@var{NN}
19770error reply
8e04817f 19771@item
ee2d5c50
AC
19772Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
19773@end table
19774
19775@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
19776@cindex @code{Q} packet
19777
19778Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
19779
19780@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 19781
ee2d5c50
AC
19782@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
19783@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 19784
8e04817f 19785Reset the entire system.
c906108c 19786
ee2d5c50
AC
19787@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
19788@cindex @code{R} packet
19789
8e04817f
AC
19790Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
19791This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
19792
19793Reply:
19794@table @samp
19795@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 19796The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
19797@end table
19798
19799@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
19800@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 19801
8e04817f
AC
19802@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19803same address.
c906108c 19804
ee2d5c50
AC
19805Reply:
19806@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19807
19808@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
19809@anchor{step with signal packet}
19810@cindex @code{S} packet
19811
8e04817f 19812Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 19813
ee2d5c50
AC
19814Reply:
19815@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19816
19817@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
19818@cindex @code{t} packet
19819
8e04817f 19820Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
19821@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
19822@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 19823
ee2d5c50
AC
19824@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
19825@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 19826
ee2d5c50 19827Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 19828
ee2d5c50
AC
19829Reply:
19830@table @samp
19831@item OK
19832thread is still alive
19833@item E@var{NN}
19834thread is dead
19835@end table
19836
19837@item @code{u} --- reserved
19838
19839Reserved for future use.
19840
19841@item @code{U} --- reserved
19842
19843Reserved for future use.
19844
19845@item @code{v} --- reserved
19846
19847Reserved for future use.
19848
19849@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 19850
ee2d5c50 19851Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19852
ee2d5c50 19853@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 19854
ee2d5c50 19855Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19856
ee2d5c50 19857@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 19858
ee2d5c50 19859Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19860
ee2d5c50
AC
19861@item @code{x} --- reserved
19862
19863Reserved for future use.
19864
19865@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
19866@cindex @code{X} packet
19867
19868@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
19869is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 19870escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 19871
ee2d5c50
AC
19872Reply:
19873@table @samp
19874@item OK
19875for success
19876@item E@var{NN}
19877for an error
19878@end table
19879
19880@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 19881
ee2d5c50 19882Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19883
ee2d5c50
AC
19884@item @code{Y} reserved
19885
19886Reserved for future use.
19887
2f870471
AC
19888@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19889@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19890@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 19891@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 19892@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 19893
2f870471
AC
19894Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
19895watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
19896@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 19897
2f870471
AC
19898Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
19899separately.
19900
512217c7
AC
19901@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
19902for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
19903remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
19904@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
19905avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
19906be implemented in an idempotent way.}
19907
19908@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19909@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19910@cindex @code{z0} packet
19911@cindex @code{Z0} packet
19912
19913Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
19914@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
19915
19916A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
19917@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
19918@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
19919breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
19920@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 19921
2f870471
AC
19922@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
19923code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
19924overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
19925target, is not defined.}
c906108c 19926
ee2d5c50
AC
19927Reply:
19928@table @samp
2f870471
AC
19929@item OK
19930success
19931@item
19932not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
19933@item E@var{NN}
19934for an error
2f870471
AC
19935@end table
19936
19937@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19938@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19939@cindex @code{z1} packet
19940@cindex @code{Z1} packet
19941
19942Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
19943address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
19944
19945A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
19946dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
19947
19948@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
19949movement.}
19950
19951Reply:
19952@table @samp
ee2d5c50 19953@item OK
2f870471
AC
19954success
19955@item
19956not supported
19957@item E@var{NN}
19958for an error
19959@end table
19960
19961@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19962@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19963@cindex @code{z2} packet
19964@cindex @code{Z2} packet
19965
19966Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
19967
19968Reply:
19969@table @samp
19970@item OK
19971success
19972@item
19973not supported
19974@item E@var{NN}
19975for an error
19976@end table
19977
19978@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19979@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19980@cindex @code{z3} packet
19981@cindex @code{Z3} packet
19982
2e834e49 19983Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
19984
19985Reply:
19986@table @samp
19987@item OK
19988success
19989@item
19990not supported
19991@item E@var{NN}
19992for an error
19993@end table
19994
2e834e49
HPN
19995@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19996@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
19997@cindex @code{z4} packet
19998@cindex @code{Z4} packet
19999
20000Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
20001
20002Reply:
20003@table @samp
20004@item OK
20005success
20006@item
20007not supported
20008@item E@var{NN}
20009for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
20010@end table
20011
20012@end table
c906108c 20013
ee2d5c50
AC
20014@node Stop Reply Packets
20015@section Stop Reply Packets
20016@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 20017
8e04817f
AC
20018The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
20019receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
20020@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
20021when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
20022number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
20023conventions is used.
c906108c 20024
ee2d5c50 20025@table @samp
c906108c 20026
ee2d5c50
AC
20027@item S@var{AA}
20028@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 20029
8e04817f 20030@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
20031@cindex @code{T} packet reply
20032
8e04817f
AC
20033@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
20034(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
20035by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
20036thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
20037@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
20038integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
20039@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
20040to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 20041
ee2d5c50
AC
20042@item W@var{AA}
20043
8e04817f 20044The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
20045applicable to certain targets.
20046
20047@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 20048
8e04817f 20049The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 20050
ee2d5c50
AC
20051@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
20052
20053@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
20054@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
20055base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
20056The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
20057the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
20058is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 20059
ee2d5c50 20060@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 20061
ee2d5c50
AC
20062@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
20063any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
20064to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
20065
0ce1b118
CV
20066@item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20067
20068@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
20069be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
20070correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
20071@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
20072system calls.
20073
20074@var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
20075system call.
20076
20077The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
20078a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
20079an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
20080packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
20081@samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
20082@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
20083
ee2d5c50
AC
20084@end table
20085
20086@node General Query Packets
20087@section General Query Packets
c906108c 20088
8e04817f 20089The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 20090
ee2d5c50 20091@table @r
c906108c 20092
ee2d5c50
AC
20093@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
20094
20095Return the current thread id.
20096
20097Reply:
20098@table @samp
20099@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 20100Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
20101@item *
20102Any other reply implies the old pid.
20103@end table
20104
20105@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
20106
20107@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 20108
8e04817f
AC
20109Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
20110may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
20111works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
20112obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
20113be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
20114sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
20115
20116NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
20117
20118Reply:
20119@table @samp
20120@item @code{m}@var{id}
20121A single thread id
20122@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
20123a comma-separated list of thread ids
20124@item @code{l}
20125(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
20126@end table
20127
20128In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
20129more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
20130will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
20131@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
20132(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 20133
ee2d5c50
AC
20134@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
20135
20136Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
20137string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
20138string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
20139@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
20140in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
20141possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
20142Mutex''.
20143
20144Reply:
20145@table @samp
20146@item @var{XX@dots{}}
20147Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
20148the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 20149attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
20150@end table
20151
20152@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 20153
8e04817f
AC
20154Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
20155digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
20156subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
20157number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
20158(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
20159returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
20160
20161NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
20162(see above).
20163
20164Reply:
20165@table @samp
20166@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
20167Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
20168returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
20169and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
20170digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
20171is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 20172digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 20173@end table
c906108c 20174
ee2d5c50
AC
20175@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
20176
20177Reply:
20178@table @samp
20179@item @code{E}@var{NN}
20180An error (such as memory fault)
20181@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
20182A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
20183@end table
20184
20185@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 20186
8e04817f
AC
20187Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
20188image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
20189response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
20190offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 20191
ee2d5c50
AC
20192Reply:
20193@table @samp
20194@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
20195@end table
20196
20197@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
20198
8e04817f
AC
20199Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
20200encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
20201
20202Reply:
20203@table @samp
20204@item *
20205@end table
20206
8e04817f 20207See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 20208
ee2d5c50
AC
20209@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
20210
20211@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
20212execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
20213Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
20214number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
20215@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
20216interpreter may have security implications}.
20217
20218Reply:
20219@table @samp
20220@item OK
8e04817f 20221A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 20222@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 20223A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 20224@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 20225Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 20226@item @samp{}
8e04817f 20227When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
20228@end table
20229
20230@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 20231
8e04817f
AC
20232Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
20233requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20234
20235Reply:
20236@table @samp
20237@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 20238The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20239@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20240The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
20241@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
20242@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
20243@end table
20244
20245@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
20246
20247Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
20248
20249@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
20250target has previously requested.
20251
20252@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
20253@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
20254will be empty.
20255
20256Reply:
20257@table @samp
20258@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 20259The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20260@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20261The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
20262encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
20263(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
20264@end table
eb12ee30 20265
ee2d5c50
AC
20266@end table
20267
20268@node Register Packet Format
20269@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 20270
8e04817f 20271The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
20272In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
20273sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
20274to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
20275byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
20276most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 20277
ee2d5c50 20278@table @r
eb12ee30 20279
8e04817f 20280@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 20281
8e04817f
AC
20282All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
2028332 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
20284registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 20285
8e04817f 20286@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 20287
8e04817f
AC
20288All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
20289thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
20290as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 20291
ee2d5c50
AC
20292@end table
20293
20294@node Examples
20295@section Examples
eb12ee30 20296
8e04817f
AC
20297Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
20298does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 20299
474c8240 20300@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
20301-> @code{R00}
20302<- @code{+}
8e04817f 20303@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 20304-> @code{?}
8e04817f 20305<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20306<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20307-> @code{+}
474c8240 20308@end smallexample
eb12ee30 20309
8e04817f 20310Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 20311
474c8240 20312@smallexample
d2c6833e 20313-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 20314<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20315-> @code{s}
20316<- @code{+}
20317@emph{time passes}
20318<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 20319-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 20320-> @code{g}
8e04817f 20321<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20322<- @code{1455@dots{}}
20323-> @code{+}
474c8240 20324@end smallexample
eb12ee30 20325
0ce1b118
CV
20326@node File-I/O remote protocol extension
20327@section File-I/O remote protocol extension
20328@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
20329
20330@menu
20331* File-I/O Overview::
20332* Protocol basics::
20333* The `F' request packet::
20334* The `F' reply packet::
20335* Memory transfer::
20336* The Ctrl-C message::
20337* Console I/O::
20338* The isatty call::
20339* The system call::
20340* List of supported calls::
20341* Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
20342* Constants::
20343* File-I/O Examples::
20344@end menu
20345
20346@node File-I/O Overview
20347@subsection File-I/O Overview
20348@cindex file-i/o overview
20349
20350The File I/O remote protocol extension (short: File-I/O) allows the
20351target to use the hosts file system and console I/O when calling various
20352system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
20353remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
20354actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
20355This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
20356
20357The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
20358it's own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
20359@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
20360translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
20361when data is transmitted.
20362
20363The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
20364when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
20365packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
20366the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
20367memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
20368is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
20369
20370The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
20371the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
20372after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
20373previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
20374request from @value{GDBN} is required.
20375
20376@smallexample
20377(gdb) continue
20378 <- target requests 'system call X'
20379 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
20380 -> GDB returns result
20381 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
20382 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
20383@end smallexample
20384
20385The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
20386for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
20387named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
20388system are not supported by this protocol.
20389
20390@node Protocol basics
20391@subsection Protocol basics
20392@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
20393
20394The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
20395as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
20396@value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
20397File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
20398of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
20399This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
20400to call the appropriate host system call:
20401
20402@itemize @bullet
20403@item
20404A unique identifier for the requested system call.
20405
20406@item
20407All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
20408in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
20409pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
20410Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
20411
20412@end itemize
20413
20414At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
20415
20416@itemize @bullet
20417@item
20418If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
20419to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
20420standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
20421expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
20422packet.
20423
20424@item
20425@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
20426representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
20427
20428@item
20429@value{GDBN} calls the system call
20430
20431@item
20432It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
20433
20434@item
20435If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
20436a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
20437target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
20438by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
20439packet.
20440
20441@end itemize
20442
20443Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
20444necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
20445
20446@itemize @bullet
20447@item
20448Return value.
20449
20450@item
20451@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
20452
20453@item
20454``Ctrl-C'' flag.
20455
20456@end itemize
20457
20458After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
20459the latest continue or step action.
20460
20461@node The `F' request packet
20462@subsection The @code{F} request packet
20463@cindex file-i/o request packet
20464@cindex @code{F} request packet
20465
20466The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
20467
20468@table @samp
20469
20470@smallexample
20471@code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20472@end smallexample
20473
20474@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
20475This is just the name of the function.
20476
20477@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
20478
20479@end table
20480
20481Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
20482of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
20483datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
20484of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
20485from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
20486string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
20487
20488@node The `F' reply packet
20489@subsection The @code{F} reply packet
20490@cindex file-i/o reply packet
20491@cindex @code{F} reply packet
20492
20493The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
20494
20495@table @samp
20496
20497@smallexample
20498@code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
20499@end smallexample
20500
20501@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
20502
20503@var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
20504This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
20505
20506@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
20507case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
20508The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
20509
20510@smallexample
20511F0,0,C
20512@end smallexample
20513
20514@noindent
20515or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
20516
20517@smallexample
20518F-1,4,C
20519@end smallexample
20520
20521@noindent
20522assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
20523
20524@end table
20525
20526@node Memory transfer
20527@subsection Memory transfer
20528@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
20529
20530Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
20531a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
20532all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
20533the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
20534it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
20535data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
20536
20537@node The Ctrl-C message
20538@subsection The Ctrl-C message
20539@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
20540
20541A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
20542reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
20543gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
20544interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
20545(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
20546packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
20547state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
20548not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
20549
20550@itemize @bullet
20551@item
20552The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
20553
20554@item
20555The system call on the host has been finished.
20556
20557@end itemize
20558
20559These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
20560returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
20561call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
20562on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
20563system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
20564as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
20565
20566@value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
20567yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
20568@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
20569before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
20570@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
20571The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
20572or the full action has been completed.
20573
20574@node Console I/O
20575@subsection Console I/O
20576@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
20577
20578By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
20579descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
20580on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
20581(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
20582by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
205830 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
20584conditions is met:
20585
20586@itemize @bullet
20587@item
20588The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
20589@code{read}
20590system call is treated as finished.
20591
20592@item
20593The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
20594line feed.
20595
20596@item
20597The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
20598character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
20599
20600@end itemize
20601
20602If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
20603the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
20604either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
20605is stopped on users request.
20606
20607@node The isatty call
20608@subsection The isatty(3) call
20609@cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
20610
20611A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
20612is implemented as it's own call inside of this protocol. It returns
206131 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
20614to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
20615would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
20616needed.
20617
20618@node The system call
20619@subsection The system(3) call
20620@cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
20621
20622The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
20623is implemented as it's own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
20624task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
20625call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
20626to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
20627in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
20628entirely of the exit status of the called command.
20629
20630Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is refused to be called
20631by @value{GDBN} by default. The user has to allow this call explicitly by
20632entering
20633
20634@table @samp
20635@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 1
20636@item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1}
20637@end table
20638
20639Disabling the @code{system} call is done by
20640
20641@table @samp
20642@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 0
20643@item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 0}
20644@end table
20645
20646The current setting is shown by typing
20647
20648@table @samp
20649@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
20650@item @code{show remote system-call-allowed}
20651@end table
20652
20653@node List of supported calls
20654@subsection List of supported calls
20655@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
20656
20657@menu
20658* open::
20659* close::
20660* read::
20661* write::
20662* lseek::
20663* rename::
20664* unlink::
20665* stat/fstat::
20666* gettimeofday::
20667* isatty::
20668* system::
20669@end menu
20670
20671@node open
20672@unnumberedsubsubsec open
20673@cindex open, file-i/o system call
20674
20675@smallexample
20676@exdent Synopsis:
20677int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
20678int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
20679
20680@exdent Request:
20681Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
20682@end smallexample
20683
20684@noindent
20685@code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20686
20687@table @code
20688@item O_CREAT
20689If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
20690rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
20691are concerned.
20692
20693@item O_EXCL
20694When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
20695an error and open() fails.
20696
20697@item O_TRUNC
20698If the file already exists and the open mode allows
20699writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
20700truncated to length 0.
20701
20702@item O_APPEND
20703The file is opened in append mode.
20704
20705@item O_RDONLY
20706The file is opened for reading only.
20707
20708@item O_WRONLY
20709The file is opened for writing only.
20710
20711@item O_RDWR
20712The file is opened for reading and writing.
20713
20714@noindent
20715Each other bit is silently ignored.
20716
20717@end table
20718
20719@noindent
20720@code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20721
20722@table @code
20723@item S_IRUSR
20724User has read permission.
20725
20726@item S_IWUSR
20727User has write permission.
20728
20729@item S_IRGRP
20730Group has read permission.
20731
20732@item S_IWGRP
20733Group has write permission.
20734
20735@item S_IROTH
20736Others have read permission.
20737
20738@item S_IWOTH
20739Others have write permission.
20740
20741@noindent
20742Each other bit is silently ignored.
20743
20744@end table
20745
20746@smallexample
20747@exdent Return value:
20748open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
20749occured.
20750
20751@exdent Errors:
20752@end smallexample
20753
20754@table @code
20755@item EEXIST
20756pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
20757
20758@item EISDIR
20759pathname refers to a directory.
20760
20761@item EACCES
20762The requested access is not allowed.
20763
20764@item ENAMETOOLONG
20765pathname was too long.
20766
20767@item ENOENT
20768A directory component in pathname does not exist.
20769
20770@item ENODEV
20771pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
20772
20773@item EROFS
20774pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
20775write access was requested.
20776
20777@item EFAULT
20778pathname is an invalid pointer value.
20779
20780@item ENOSPC
20781No space on device to create the file.
20782
20783@item EMFILE
20784The process already has the maximum number of files open.
20785
20786@item ENFILE
20787The limit on the total number of files open on the system
20788has been reached.
20789
20790@item EINTR
20791The call was interrupted by the user.
20792@end table
20793
20794@node close
20795@unnumberedsubsubsec close
20796@cindex close, file-i/o system call
20797
20798@smallexample
20799@exdent Synopsis:
20800int close(int fd);
20801
20802@exdent Request:
20803Fclose,fd
20804
20805@exdent Return value:
20806close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
20807
20808@exdent Errors:
20809@end smallexample
20810
20811@table @code
20812@item EBADF
20813fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
20814
20815@item EINTR
20816The call was interrupted by the user.
20817@end table
20818
20819@node read
20820@unnumberedsubsubsec read
20821@cindex read, file-i/o system call
20822
20823@smallexample
20824@exdent Synopsis:
20825int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
20826
20827@exdent Request:
20828Fread,fd,bufptr,count
20829
20830@exdent Return value:
20831On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
20832Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
20833returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
20834
20835@exdent Errors:
20836@end smallexample
20837
20838@table @code
20839@item EBADF
20840fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20841reading.
20842
20843@item EFAULT
20844buf is an invalid pointer value.
20845
20846@item EINTR
20847The call was interrupted by the user.
20848@end table
20849
20850@node write
20851@unnumberedsubsubsec write
20852@cindex write, file-i/o system call
20853
20854@smallexample
20855@exdent Synopsis:
20856int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
20857
20858@exdent Request:
20859Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
20860
20861@exdent Return value:
20862On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
20863Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
20864is returned.
20865
20866@exdent Errors:
20867@end smallexample
20868
20869@table @code
20870@item EBADF
20871fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20872writing.
20873
20874@item EFAULT
20875buf is an invalid pointer value.
20876
20877@item EFBIG
20878An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
20879host specific maximum file size allowed.
20880
20881@item ENOSPC
20882No space on device to write the data.
20883
20884@item EINTR
20885The call was interrupted by the user.
20886@end table
20887
20888@node lseek
20889@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
20890@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
20891
20892@smallexample
20893@exdent Synopsis:
20894long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
20895
20896@exdent Request:
20897Flseek,fd,offset,flag
20898@end smallexample
20899
20900@code{flag} is one of:
20901
20902@table @code
20903@item SEEK_SET
20904The offset is set to offset bytes.
20905
20906@item SEEK_CUR
20907The offset is set to its current location plus offset
20908bytes.
20909
20910@item SEEK_END
20911The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
20912bytes.
20913@end table
20914
20915@smallexample
20916@exdent Return value:
20917On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
20918the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
20919value of -1 is returned.
20920
20921@exdent Errors:
20922@end smallexample
20923
20924@table @code
20925@item EBADF
20926fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
20927
20928@item ESPIPE
20929fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
20930
20931@item EINVAL
20932flag is not a proper value.
20933
20934@item EINTR
20935The call was interrupted by the user.
20936@end table
20937
20938@node rename
20939@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
20940@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
20941
20942@smallexample
20943@exdent Synopsis:
20944int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
20945
20946@exdent Request:
20947Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
20948
20949@exdent Return value:
20950On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
20951
20952@exdent Errors:
20953@end smallexample
20954
20955@table @code
20956@item EISDIR
20957newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
20958directory.
20959
20960@item EEXIST
20961newpath is a non-empty directory.
20962
20963@item EBUSY
20964oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
20965process.
20966
20967@item EINVAL
20968An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
20969of itself.
20970
20971@item ENOTDIR
20972A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
20973path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
20974and newpath exists but is not a directory.
20975
20976@item EFAULT
20977oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
20978
20979@item EACCES
20980No access to the file or the path of the file.
20981
20982@item ENAMETOOLONG
20983
20984oldpath or newpath was too long.
20985
20986@item ENOENT
20987A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
20988
20989@item EROFS
20990The file is on a read-only filesystem.
20991
20992@item ENOSPC
20993The device containing the file has no room for the new
20994directory entry.
20995
20996@item EINTR
20997The call was interrupted by the user.
20998@end table
20999
21000@node unlink
21001@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
21002@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
21003
21004@smallexample
21005@exdent Synopsis:
21006int unlink(const char *pathname);
21007
21008@exdent Request:
21009Funlink,pathnameptr/len
21010
21011@exdent Return value:
21012On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21013
21014@exdent Errors:
21015@end smallexample
21016
21017@table @code
21018@item EACCES
21019No access to the file or the path of the file.
21020
21021@item EPERM
21022The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
21023
21024@item EBUSY
21025The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
21026being used by another process.
21027
21028@item EFAULT
21029pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21030
21031@item ENAMETOOLONG
21032pathname was too long.
21033
21034@item ENOENT
21035A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21036
21037@item ENOTDIR
21038A component of the path is not a directory.
21039
21040@item EROFS
21041The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21042
21043@item EINTR
21044The call was interrupted by the user.
21045@end table
21046
21047@node stat/fstat
21048@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
21049@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
21050@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
21051
21052@smallexample
21053@exdent Synopsis:
21054int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
21055int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
21056
21057@exdent Request:
21058Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
21059Ffstat,fd,bufptr
21060
21061@exdent Return value:
21062On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21063
21064@exdent Errors:
21065@end smallexample
21066
21067@table @code
21068@item EBADF
21069fd is not a valid open file.
21070
21071@item ENOENT
21072A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
21073path is an empty string.
21074
21075@item ENOTDIR
21076A component of the path is not a directory.
21077
21078@item EFAULT
21079pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21080
21081@item EACCES
21082No access to the file or the path of the file.
21083
21084@item ENAMETOOLONG
21085pathname was too long.
21086
21087@item EINTR
21088The call was interrupted by the user.
21089@end table
21090
21091@node gettimeofday
21092@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
21093@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
21094
21095@smallexample
21096@exdent Synopsis:
21097int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
21098
21099@exdent Request:
21100Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
21101
21102@exdent Return value:
21103On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
21104
21105@exdent Errors:
21106@end smallexample
21107
21108@table @code
21109@item EINVAL
21110tz is a non-NULL pointer.
21111
21112@item EFAULT
21113tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
21114@end table
21115
21116@node isatty
21117@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
21118@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
21119
21120@smallexample
21121@exdent Synopsis:
21122int isatty(int fd);
21123
21124@exdent Request:
21125Fisatty,fd
21126
21127@exdent Return value:
21128Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
21129
21130@exdent Errors:
21131@end smallexample
21132
21133@table @code
21134@item EINTR
21135The call was interrupted by the user.
21136@end table
21137
21138@node system
21139@unnumberedsubsubsec system
21140@cindex system, file-i/o system call
21141
21142@smallexample
21143@exdent Synopsis:
21144int system(const char *command);
21145
21146@exdent Request:
21147Fsystem,commandptr/len
21148
21149@exdent Return value:
21150The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
21151of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
21152command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
21153system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
21154In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
21155
21156@exdent Errors:
21157@end smallexample
21158
21159@table @code
21160@item EINTR
21161The call was interrupted by the user.
21162@end table
21163
21164@node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21165@subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21166@cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21167
21168@menu
21169* Integral datatypes::
21170* Pointer values::
21171* struct stat::
21172* struct timeval::
21173@end menu
21174
21175@node Integral datatypes
21176@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
21177@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21178
21179The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
21180
21181@smallexample
21182int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
21183@end smallexample
21184
21185@code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
21186implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
21187
21188@code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
21189
21190@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
21191in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
21192
21193@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
21194
21195All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
21196structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
21197byte order.
21198
21199@node Pointer values
21200@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
21201@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
21202
21203Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
21204is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
21205transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
21206are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
21207
21208@smallexample
21209@code{1aaf/12}
21210@end smallexample
21211
21212@noindent
21213which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
21214The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
21215the trailing null byte. Example:
21216
21217@smallexample
21218``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
21219@end smallexample
21220
21221@noindent
21222is transmitted as
21223
21224@smallexample
21225@code{123456/d}
21226@end smallexample
21227
21228@node struct stat
21229@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
21230@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
21231
21232The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
21233as follows:
21234
21235@smallexample
21236struct stat @{
21237 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
21238 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
21239 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
21240 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
21241 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
21242 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
21243 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
21244 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
21245 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
21246 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
21247 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
21248 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
21249 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
21250@};
21251@end smallexample
21252
21253The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21254approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21255structure is of size 64 bytes.
21256
21257The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
21258range of values.
21259
21260@smallexample
21261st_dev: 0 file
21262 1 console
21263
21264st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21265
21266st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
21267 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
21268
21269st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21270
21271st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21272
21273st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21274
21275st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
21276 These values have a host and file system dependent
21277 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
21278 don't support exact timing values.
21279@end smallexample
21280
21281The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
21282responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
21283continuing.
21284
21285Note that due to size differences between the host and target
21286representation of stat members, these members could eventually
21287get truncated on the target.
21288
21289@node struct timeval
21290@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
21291@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
21292
21293The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
21294is defined as follows:
21295
21296@smallexample
21297struct timeval @{
21298 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
21299 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
21300@};
21301@end smallexample
21302
21303The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21304approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21305structure is of size 8 bytes.
21306
21307@node Constants
21308@subsection Constants
21309@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
21310
21311The following values are used for the constants inside of the
21312protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
21313values before and after the call as needed.
21314
21315@menu
21316* Open flags::
21317* mode_t values::
21318* Errno values::
21319* Lseek flags::
21320* Limits::
21321@end menu
21322
21323@node Open flags
21324@unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
21325@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
21326
21327All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
21328
21329@smallexample
21330 O_RDONLY 0x0
21331 O_WRONLY 0x1
21332 O_RDWR 0x2
21333 O_APPEND 0x8
21334 O_CREAT 0x200
21335 O_TRUNC 0x400
21336 O_EXCL 0x800
21337@end smallexample
21338
21339@node mode_t values
21340@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
21341@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
21342
21343All values are given in octal representation.
21344
21345@smallexample
21346 S_IFREG 0100000
21347 S_IFDIR 040000
21348 S_IRUSR 0400
21349 S_IWUSR 0200
21350 S_IXUSR 0100
21351 S_IRGRP 040
21352 S_IWGRP 020
21353 S_IXGRP 010
21354 S_IROTH 04
21355 S_IWOTH 02
21356 S_IXOTH 01
21357@end smallexample
21358
21359@node Errno values
21360@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
21361@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
21362
21363All values are given in decimal representation.
21364
21365@smallexample
21366 EPERM 1
21367 ENOENT 2
21368 EINTR 4
21369 EBADF 9
21370 EACCES 13
21371 EFAULT 14
21372 EBUSY 16
21373 EEXIST 17
21374 ENODEV 19
21375 ENOTDIR 20
21376 EISDIR 21
21377 EINVAL 22
21378 ENFILE 23
21379 EMFILE 24
21380 EFBIG 27
21381 ENOSPC 28
21382 ESPIPE 29
21383 EROFS 30
21384 ENAMETOOLONG 91
21385 EUNKNOWN 9999
21386@end smallexample
21387
21388 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
21389 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
21390
21391@node Lseek flags
21392@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
21393@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
21394
21395@smallexample
21396 SEEK_SET 0
21397 SEEK_CUR 1
21398 SEEK_END 2
21399@end smallexample
21400
21401@node Limits
21402@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
21403@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
21404
21405All values are given in decimal representation.
21406
21407@smallexample
21408 INT_MIN -2147483648
21409 INT_MAX 2147483647
21410 UINT_MAX 4294967295
21411 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
21412 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
21413 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
21414@end smallexample
21415
21416@node File-I/O Examples
21417@subsection File-I/O Examples
21418@cindex file-i/o examples
21419
21420Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21421address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
21422
21423@smallexample
21424<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
21425@emph{request memory read from target}
21426-> @code{m1234,6}
21427<- XXXXXX
21428@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
21429-> @code{F6}
21430@end smallexample
21431
21432Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21433address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
21434
21435@smallexample
21436<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21437@emph{request memory write to target}
21438-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21439@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
21440-> @code{F6}
21441@end smallexample
21442
21443Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
21444file descriptor (EBADF):
21445
21446@smallexample
21447<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21448-> @code{F-1,9}
21449@end smallexample
21450
21451Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
21452host is called:
21453
21454@smallexample
21455<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21456-> @code{F-1,4,C}
21457<- @code{T02}
21458@end smallexample
21459
21460Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
21461host is called:
21462
21463@smallexample
21464<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21465-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21466<- @code{T02}
21467@end smallexample
21468
aab4e0ec 21469@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 21470
6826cf00
EZ
21471@include fdl.texi
21472
6d2ebf8b 21473@node Index
c906108c
SS
21474@unnumbered Index
21475
21476@printindex cp
21477
21478@tex
21479% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
21480% meantime:
21481\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
21482\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
21483\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
21484\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
21485\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
21486\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
21487\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
21488\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
21489\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
21490\page\colophon
21491% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
21492@end tex
21493
c906108c 21494@bye
This page took 1.4803 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.